VOLUSON S6S8 BT15 Basic Service Manual - SM - 5589164 - 4
VOLUSON S6S8 BT15 Basic Service Manual - SM - 5589164 - 4
VOLUSON S6S8 BT15 Basic Service Manual - SM - 5589164 - 4
• Voluson™S8 systems
• Voluson™S6 systems
0459
GE VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
Important Precautions
- i
GE VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
ii -
GE VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
VAROITUS
(FI)
ΠΡΟΕΙ∆ΟΠΟΙΗΣΗ
(EL)
FIGYELMEZTETÉS
(HU)
- iii
GE VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
VÝSTRAHA
(CS)
BRÎDINÂJUMS
(LV)
iv -
GE VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
ĮSPĖJIMAS
(LT)
OSTRZEŻENIE
(PL)
ATENŢIE
(RO)
- v
GE VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
ОСТОРОЖНО!
(RU)
UPOZORNENIE
(SK)
DİKKAT
(TR)
vi -
GE VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
(JA)
(ZH-CN)
(KO)
- vii
GE VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
DAMAGE IN TRANSPORTATION
All packages should be closely examined at time of delivery. If damage is apparent write “Damage In
Shipment” on ALL copies of the freight or express bill BEFORE delivery is accepted or “signed for” by
a GE representative or hospital receiving agent. Whether noted or concealed, damage MUST be
reported to the carrier immediately upon discovery, or in any event, within 14 days after receipt, and the
contents and containers held for inspection by the carrier. A transportation company will not pay a claim
for damage if an inspection is not requested within this 14 day period.
The purchaser of GE equipment shall only utilize qualified personnel (i.e., GE’s field engineers,
personnel of third-party service companies with equivalent training, or licensed electricians) to perform
electrical servicing on the equipment.
viii -
GE VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
LEGAL NOTES
The contents of this publication may not be copied or duplicated in any form, in whole or in part, without
prior written permission of GE Healthcare.
GE may revise this publication from time to time without written notice.
TRADEMARKS
All products and their name brands are trademarks of their respective holders.
COPYRIGHTS
All Material Copyright©2014-17 by General Electric Inc. All Rights Reserved.
- ix
GE VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
Revision History
x -
GE VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
CHAPTER 1
Introduction
Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1
Purpose of Chapter 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1
Purpose of Service Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1
Typical Users of the Basic Service Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2
Models Covered by this Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2
Purpose of Operator Manual(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3
Customer Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 15
Contact Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 15
System Manufacturer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 15
Table of Contents i
GE VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
CHAPTER 2
Site Preparation
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 1
Purpose of Chapter 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 1
Facility Needs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 6
Purchaser Responsibilities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 6
Mandatory Site Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 7
Site Recommendations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 7
Recommended Ultrasound Room Layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 8
Networking Setup Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 9
Stand-alone Unit (without Network Connection) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 9
Unit Connected to Hospital’s Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 9
Purpose of the DICOM Network Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 9
DICOM Option Pre-installation Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 9
ii Table of Contents
GE VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
CHAPTER 3
Setup Instructions
Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 1
The Purpose of Chapter 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 1
Scanner Shutdown . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 29
Transducer Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 31
Printer Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 32
Installing Digital Black & White Printer Sony UP-D898 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 32
Installing Digital Color Printer Sony UP-D25MD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 32
Installing the Bluetooth Deskjet Printer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 33
Installing the USB Bluetooth Adapter and the Bluetooth Software . . . . 3 - 33
Configuration of the Bluetooth Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 36
Prepare the Printer and connect the Bluetooth Printer Adapter . . . . . . 3 - 38
HP Officejet H470 Printer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 38
HP Officejet 100 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 39
Installing the printer software/driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 39
Configuration of Printer Properties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 42
DeskJet Color Printer (HP Officejet H470, HP Officejet 100) - Printer
Properties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 43
Printer Installation manually . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 44
Adjustment of Printer Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 48
UP-D898 - Printer Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 49
P95D - Printer Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 50
UP-D25MD - Printer Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 52
Remote Control Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 55
Report Printer Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 55
Cellular Modem Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 56
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 56
Tools Required . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 56
Parts Required . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 56
Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 57
Installation procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 58
Modem configuration procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 63
System Configuration. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 65
System Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 65
To invoke the Setup procedure: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 65
How to enter Date and Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 66
How to enter Hospital Name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 66
How to change Language and/or EUM Language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 66
How to activate Screen Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 67
How to adjust function of the Footswitch (Left/Middle/Right) . . . . . . . . . 3 - 68
How to change the Keyboard Layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 68
How to configure Service Platform . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 68
Measure Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 69
To invoke the Setup procedure: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 69
On-Board Optional Peripherals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 70
External I/O Connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 71
iv Table of Contents
GE VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
Available Probes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 73
Software/Option Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 73
Connectivity Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 74
Connectivity Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 74
The Dataflow Concept . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 74
Dataflow Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 75
Stand-alone Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 76
Voluson® + PC (with 4D View Software) within a “Sneaker Net” . . . . . 3 - 76
Connection between Voluson® and DICOM Server . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 76
Wireless Network Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 77
Description of “Netgear” Configuration Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 79
Paperwork . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 92
Product Locator Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 92
User Manual(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 92
Table of Contents v
GE VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
CHAPTER 4
Functional Checks
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 1
Purpose of Chapter 4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 1
Required Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 1
General Procedure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 2
Power On / Boot Up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 2
Scanner Power On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 2
Power Off / Shutdown . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 4
Scanner Shutdown . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 4
System Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 6
Control Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 6
Monitor Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 7
Functional Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 8
2D Mode Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 9
Additional (optional) Operating Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 13
B-Flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 13
XTD-View Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 13
Coded Contrast Imaging Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 14
M Mode Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 15
MCFM Mode Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 16
Spectral Doppler Mode Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 17
Color Doppler Mode Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 19
Volume Mode Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 21
Pre-Volume Mode Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 22
Functions after the Acquisition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 24
3D/4D Sub Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 26
Using Cine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 28
Activating Cine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 28
Cine-Split Function (Multiple Format) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 28
Activating 2D Cine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 28
Spectral Doppler- or M Cine Loop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 28
Activating 3D Rotation Cine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 28
Activating Volume Cine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 28
Activating Auto Cine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 28
Activating Cine Calc . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 29
Generic Measurements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 30
Distance and Tissue Depth Measurements (2D and M Mode) . . . . . . . 4 - 30
Circumference/Area Measurements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 31
Volume Measurements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 31
Multiplane Measurements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 31
vi Table of Contents
GE VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
Peripheral Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 53
ECG Check Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 53
Control Console Positioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 53
Brakes and Direction (Swivel) Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 53
Site Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 55
CHAPTER 5
Components and Functions (Theory)
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 1
Purpose of Chapter 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 1
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 2
Description of Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Operating Modes . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 6
B-Mode or 2D-Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 6
B-Flow (optional) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 6
Coded Harmonic Imaging (HI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 6
XTD-View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 6
Coded Contrast Imaging (optional) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 6
M-Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 6
MCFM Mode (M Mode + Color Flow Mode) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 6
Color Doppler Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 7
Color Flow Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 7
Power Doppler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 7
Bi-Directional Angio (HD-Flow Mode) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 7
Tissue Doppler (option) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 7
Pulsed (PW) Doppler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 8
3D Imaging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 8
3D Data Collection and Reconstruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 8
3D Image Presentation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 8
3D Rendering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 9
Block diagram Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 10
Front End Block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 11
Back End Block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 11
OPIO Block diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 11
Data Flow Control Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 12
B-Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 12
Special B-Mode Techniques . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 12
M-Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 13
D-Mode (Pulsed Wave- and Continuous Wave Doppler) . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 13
D-Mode Autotrace (draws PC-calculated envelope to D-Spectrum) . . . 5 - 13
CFM-Mode (Color Flow Mode) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 14
3D-Mode (Freezes after 1 volume sweep) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 14
Real Time 4D-Mode (nonstop volume rendering) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 14
XBeam CRI-Mode (CrossBeam Compound Resolution Imaging) . . . . . 5 - 14
VCI-Mode (Volume Contrast Imaging) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 14
Archive write mode (store Image to Archive) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 14
Description of Software Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 15
3D/4D Advanced . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 16
Real Time 4D . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 16
HDLive(3D) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 16
3D/4D Expert . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 16
viii Table of Contents
GE VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
Real Time 4D . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 16
Real Time 4D Biopsy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 16
VCI - Volume Contrast Imaging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 16
T.U.I. - Tomographic Ultrasound Imaging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 16
Advanced VCI / SingleView . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 17
VCI Omni View - Volume Contrast Imaging (any plane) . . . . 5 - 17
SingleView - Volume Contrast Imaging (any plane) . . . . . . . 5 - 17
DICOM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 17
B-Flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 17
Elastography . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 17
Coded Contrast Imaging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 17
SonoVCAD Heart- Computer Assisted Heart Diagnosis Package . . . . 5 - 18
SonoAVC follicle - Sono Automated Volume Count . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 18
SonoVCAD labor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 18
Anatomical M-Mode (AMM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 18
Advanced SRI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 18
SonoNT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 19
STIC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 19
ScanAssistant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 19
TUI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 19
Realtime 4D Biopsy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 20
Inversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 20
VOCAL II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 20
SonoIT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 20
SonoBiometry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 20
Description of Hardware Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 21
CW - Continuous Wave Doppler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 21
DVR Recorder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 21
ECG Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 21
Wireless Network Adapter (WLAN - Wireless Local Area Network) . . . 5 - 21
Scan/Freeze Footswitch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 21
CPS2 Battery Assy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 21
Data Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 21
FrontEnd Processor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 23
PIRIII - Probe Interface board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 24
BF128II / BF64II - Beam former board . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 25
RFS/RFS-G - Radio Frequency interface and System controller . . . . . . . . 5 - 26
RFS - FPGA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 26
BackEnd Processor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 28
Hard Disk Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 29
SOM (System On Module) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 29
Congatec . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 29
DVR - Digital Video Recorder (option) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 30
Table of Contents ix
GE VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
Internal I/O . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 31
Monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 36
External I/O . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 37
Peripherals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 38
Recording Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 38
DVD Recorder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 38
Printers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 38
Black & White Digital Printer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 38
Color Digital Printer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 38
Color Deskjet Printer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 38
DVD+R/RW Drive (Writer) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 38
ECG Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 38
Wireless Network Adapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 38
Footswitch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 38
CPS2 Battery Assy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 38
Power Distribution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 39
ACFE - Primary Power Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 39
CPS2/CPS2 with Battery assy Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 40
Power Distribution Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 41
Power Up Sequence Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 42
Power Up Sequence Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 42
Power Down Sequence Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 43
Mechanical Concept and Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 43
Functions of ACFE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 43
ACDC - primary DC Power Supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 44
Function of ACDC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 44
DCDC - main DC Power Supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 44
4D Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 44
Mechanical Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 45
Physical Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 45
LCD Monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 46
OPIO Positioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 46
Rotation of the Control Console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 47
Height Adjustment of the OPIO Console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 47
Air Flow Distribution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 48
x Table of Contents
GE VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
Service Platform . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 49
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 49
Access / Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 49
Local Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 49
Local(Extended) Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 50
Remote Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 51
Service Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 56
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 56
Access / Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 56
Service Login . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 56
Auto Tester . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 56
Update . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 57
FMI from DVD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 57
ASI - Additional Software Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 57
Restore Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 57
TCP/IP Buffersize . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 57
Common Service Desktop (CSD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 57
Request for Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 57
Delete all Patients . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 57
Export System Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 57
Keyboard Layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 58
Monitor Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 58
Load Application Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 58
Table of Contents xi
GE VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
Access/Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 61
Before Recovering or Initializing the Hard disk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 62
Voluson Maintenance System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 64
Media . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 64
Advanced . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 64
About . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 64
Exit/Reboot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 64
Halt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 64
Media Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 65
Exit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 65
Restore . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 65
Initialize . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 68
NewDisk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 68
BIOS “Boot Priority Order” Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 69
New Hard Disk Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 72
Advanced Functions Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 76
Exit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 76
Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 76
SSHD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 77
Restore . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 77
Initialize Harddisk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 77
ServiceTools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 77
Service Tools Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 78
Exit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 78
Shell . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 78
USBTree . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 79
SmartHDDtest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 79
HDDWipeTool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 79
CollectLogs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 80
Bios Update . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 81
Voluson Log Viewer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 81
After Recovering or Initializing the Hard disk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 82
Memory Check in LINUX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 84
CHAPTER 6
Service Adjustments
Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 - 1
Purpose of Chapter 6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 - 1
Regulatory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 - 1
CHAPTER 7
Diagnostics/Troubleshooting
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 1
Purpose of Chapter 7 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 1
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 1
Error Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 71
CHAPTER 8
Replacement Procedures
Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 1
Purpose of Chapter 8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 1
Returning/Shipping System, Probes and Repair Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 3
Replacement of Monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 25
Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 25
Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 25
Remove Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 25
Installation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 26
Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 27
Installation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 30
Replacement of OPIO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 31
Manpower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 31
Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 31
Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 31
Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 31
Installation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 34
Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 69
Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 69
Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 69
Installation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 70
Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 80
Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 80
Installation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 80
Preparations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 93
Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 93
Installation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 94
CHAPTER 9
Renewal Parts
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 1
Purpose of Chapter 9 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 1
List of Abbreviations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 2
LCD Monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 6
OPIO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 7
Nest Box Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 10
Mechanical Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 13
Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 15
System Manuals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 18
Probes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 19
2D-Probes - Curved Array Transducers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 19
2D-Probes - Linear Array Transducers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 20
Real-Time 4D Volume Probes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 21
2D-Probes - Phased Array Transducers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 22
CW-Doppler - Pencil Probes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 23
Power Cord . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 24
CHAPTER 10
Care & Maintenance
Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 1
Periodic Maintenance Inspections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 1
Purpose of Chapter 10 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 1
Why do Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 2
Keeping Records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 2
Quality Assurance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 2
Tools Required . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 5
Special Tools, Supplies and Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 5
Specific Requirements for Care & Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 5
System Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 6
Preliminary Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 6
Functional Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 7
System Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 7
Peripheral/Option Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 8
Input Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 8
Mains Cable Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 8
Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 8
General Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 8
Physical Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 9
Optional Diagnostic Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 9
Probe Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 10
Probe Related Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 10
Basic Probe Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 10
Basic Probe Cleaning and/or Disinfection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 10
Disinfection by means of the RIC-Holder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 11
Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 19
Generic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 19
Data Sheet for Enclosure Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 21
Earth Leakage Current Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 21
Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 21
Generic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 22
Type CF Patient Leakage Current Test - ECG Leads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 23
Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 23
Generic Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 23
Type BF Patient Leakage Current Test - Probe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 24
Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 24
Generic Procedure on Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 25
Type CF Patient Auxiliary current - ECG Lead to Probe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 25
Type BF Patient Leakage current - Mains to Probe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 26
Type CF Patient Leakage current - Mains to ECG lead . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 26
Total Patient leakage current : Type CF probe to ground(Only for Europe) 10 - 27
Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 27
Generic Procedure for measurement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 27
Total Patient leakage current : Mains to Type CF probe (Only for Europe) . 10 - 28
Chapter 1
Introduction
Section 1-1
Overview
1-1-1 Purpose of Chapter 1
This chapter describes important issues related to safely servicing the Voluson™ S8 and/or Voluson™
S6 ultrasound system. The service provider must read and understand all the information presented in
this manual before installing or servicing a unit.
This Service Manual provides installation and service information for Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6
Ultrasound Scanning System and contains the following chapters:
Section 1-2
Important Conventions
1-2-1 Conventions Used in this Manual
Model Designations
This manual covers the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 ultrasound units listed on page 1-2.
Icons
Pictures, or icons, are used wherever they reinforce the printed message. The icons, labels and
conventions used on the product and in the service information are described in this chapter.
Various levels of safety precaution messages may be found on the equipment and in the service
information. The different levels of concern are identified by a flag word that precedes the precautionary
message. Known or potential hazards are labeled in one of following ways:
CAUTION Indicates the presence of a hazard that will or can cause minor personal injury and property
!! CAUTION:
damage if instructions are ignored.
LASER
LIGHT
Other hazard icons make you aware of specific procedures that should be followed.
AVOID STATIC ELECTRICITY TAG AND LOCK OUT WEAR EYE PROTECTION
TAG
& EYE
LOCKOUT PROTECTION
Signed Date
or
Device Listing/Certification Labels Laboratory logo or labels denoting conformance with industry
Rear side of the unit
safety standards such as UL or IEC.
Council Directive 93/42/EEC concerning medical devices: The Rear side of the unit
xxxx CE mark affixed to the equipment testifies compliance to the
On each probe
directive.
“CAUTION
This unit weighs...
Special care must be used to avoid..."
This precaution is intended to prevent injury that may result if Used in the Service and User Manual
one person attempt to move the unit considerable distances or which should be adjacent to equipment
on an incline due to the weight of the unit. at all times for quick reference.
"DANGER - The system is not designed for use with flammable anesthetic
Indicated in the Service Manual.
Risk of explosion used in..." gases.
"Protective Earth" Indicates the protective earth (grounding) Rear of system at mains switch
terminal. (on primary power supply)
Section 1-3
Safety Considerations
1-3-1 Introduction
The following safety precautions must be observed during all phases of operation, service and repair of
this equipment. Failure to comply with these precautions or with specific warnings elsewhere in this
manual, violates safety standards of design, manufacture and intended use of the equipment.
WARNING
WARNING USE EXTREME CAUTION WHEN ELEVATING THE UNIT, OR IF IT IS RAISED FOR A
!! WARNING:
REPAIR OR MOVED ALONG ANY INCLINE. THE VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
SYSTEM MAY BECOME UNSTABLE WHICH COULD CAUSE A TIP OVER.
WARNING
WARNING ULTRASOUND PROBES ARE HIGHLY SENSITIVE MEDICAL INSTRUMENTS THAT
!! WARNING:
CAN EASILY BE DAMAGED BY IMPROPER HANDLING. USE CARE WHEN
HANDLING AND PROTECT FROM DAMAGE WHEN NOT IN USE. DO NOT USE A
DAMAGED OR DEFECTIVE PROBE. FAILURE TO FOLLOW THESE PRECAUTIONS
CAN RESULT IN SERIOUS INJURY AND EQUIPMENT DAMAGE.
WARNING
WARNING NEVER USE A PROBE THAT HAS FALLEN TO THE FLOOR.
!! WARNING:
EVEN IF IT LOOKS OK, IT MAY BE DAMAGED.
CAUTION Always lower and center the Operator I/O Panel before moving the scanner.
!! CAUTION:
CAUTION Before you move or transport the system, make sure to lock the LCD monitor firmly and flip
!! CAUTION:
down the monitor to prevent damage to the system.
NOTE: Special care should be taken when transporting the unit in a vehicle:
The power outlet used for this equipment should not be shared with other types of equipment.
Both the system power cable and the power connector meet international electrical standards.
1-3-4-2 Probes
All the probes for the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 are designed and manufactured to provide trouble-
free, reliable service. To ensure this, correct handling of probes is important and the following points
should be noted:
• Do not drop a probe or strike it against a hard surface, as this may damage the transducer elements,
acoustic lens, or housing.
• Inspect the probe prior to each use for damage or degradation to the Housing, Cable strain relief,
Lens and Seal.
• Do not use a cracked or damaged probe. In this event, call your field service representative
immediately to obtain a replacement.
• Avoid pulling, pinching or kinking the probe cable, since a damaged cable may compromise the
electrical safety of the probe.
• To avoid the risk of a probe accidentally falling, do not allow the probe cables to become entangled,
or to be caught in the machine’s wheels.
• Never immerse the probe connector or adapter into any liquid.
NOTE: For detailed information on handling probes, refer to the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Basic User
Manual and the care card supplied with the probe.
WARNING
WARNING DO NOT attempt to use different peripherals and accessories (brand and model;
!! WARNING:
connected via USB ports) other than approved and provided by GE Healthcare!
The ultrasound system is an extremely sensitive and complex medical system.
Any unauthorized peripherals may cause system failure or damage!
The Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 is equipped with an isolation transformer to provide the required
separation from mains for both, the system and the auxiliary devices.
One AUX main outlet is located at the primary power supply. It is used for connecting the threefold
splitter whose outlets are led to the shelves intend for auxiliary devices (e.g., printers) and the AUX main
outlet that is accessible on the back of the control console.
The IEC 60601-1-1 standard provides a guideline for safely interconnecting medical devices in systems.
“Equipment connected to the analog or digital interface must comply with the respective IEC/UL
standards (e.g. IEC 60950 / UL 60950 for data processing equipment and IEC 60601-1 / UL 60601-1
for medical equipment).
Special care has to be taken, if the device is connected to computer network (e.g., Ethernet), because
other devices could be connected without any control. There could be a potential difference between
the protective earth and any line of the computer network including the shield.
In this case the only way to operate the system safely is to use an isolated signal link with minimum
4mm creepage distance, 2.5mm air clearance of the isolation device. For computer networks there are
media converters available which convert the electrical to optical signals. Please consider that this
converter has to comply with IEC xxx standards* and is battery operated or connected to the isolation
mains output of the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 ultrasound system.
NOTICE The system integrator (any person connecting the medical device to other devices) is responsible
!! NOTICE:
that the connections are safe.
If in doubt, consult the technical service department or your local representative.
CAUTION The leakage current of the entire system including any / all auxiliary equipment must not exceed
!! CAUTION:
the limit values as per EN 60601-1-1:1990 (IEC 60601-1-1) respectively other valid national or
international standards. All equipment must comply with UL, CSA and IEC requirements.
CAUTION Please observe that some printers may not be medical devices! If the Bluetooth Printer and/or
!! CAUTION:
Line Printers are no medical devices, they have to be located outside of the patient environment
(according to IEC 60601-1 / UL 60601-1).
1,5 m
2,5 m
1,5 m 1,5 m
CAUTION Auxiliary equipment must only be connected to the main console with the special main outlet
!! CAUTION:
provided for the electrical safety of the system.
CAUTION Auxiliary equipment with direct main connection requires galvanic separation of the signal and/
!! CAUTION:
or control leads.
For hardware installation procedures see: Chapter 3 - Connection of Auxiliary Devices, on page 3-12.
WARNING
WARNING After each installation, the leakage currents have to be measured according to
!! WARNING:
IEC 60601-1 respectively UL 60601-1.
NOTICE All peripherals mounted on the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 system chassis must be firmly secured in
!! NOTICE:
position.
2 5
3
4 6
7
8
10
11
Figure 1-2 Main Label (located on left rear of Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6) - example
1-3-6-2 UL Label
The UL label is located below the main label.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
9
2
2 Symbol “Do not use the following devices near this system”
5 CE mark
6 Rx Only mark
9 Caution
WARNING EXPLOSION
WARNING WARNING
!! WARNING:
WARNING DO
WARNING NOT SUBSTITUTE PARTS OR MODIFY EQUIPMENT
!! WARNING:
Signed Date
Beware that the Power Supply, Front End Processor and Back End Processor may be energized even
if the power is turned off when the cord is still plugged into the AC Outlet.
UT
• system must be lowered to its minimum height with monitor flapped down (see Figure on Figure 3-5)
• the Control Console has to be centered and locked in “unextended” position
Equipment being returned must be clean and free of blood and other infectious substances.
GEHC policy states that body fluids must be properly removed from any part or equipment prior to
shipment. GEHC employees, as well as customers, are responsible for ensuring that parts/equipment
have been properly decontaminated prior to shipment. Under no circumstance should a part or
equipment with visible body fluids be taken or shipped from a clinic or site (for example, body coils or
and ultrasound probe).
The purpose of the regulation is to protect employees in the transportation industry, as well as the
people who will receive or open this package.
Section 1-4
Electromagnetic Compatibility (EMC)
1-4-1 What is EMC?
Electromagnetic compatibility describes a level of performance of a device within its electromagnetic
environment. This environment consists of the device itself and its surroundings including other
equipment, power sources and persons with which the device must interface. Inadequate compatibility
results when a susceptible device fails to perform as intended due interference from its environment or
when the device produces unacceptable levels of emission to its environment. This interference is often
referred to as radio–frequency or electromagnetic interference (RFI/EMI) and can be radiated through
space or conducted over interconnecting power of signal cables. In addition to electromagnetic energy,
EMC also includes possible effects from electrical fields, magnetic fields, electrostatic discharge and
disturbances in the electrical power supply.
For applicable standards please refer to Chapter 2 in the Basic User Manual of the Voluson™S8 /
Voluson™S6 ultrasound system.
1-4-2 Compliance
The Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 unit conforms to all applicable conducted and radiated emission limits
and to immunity from electrostatic discharge, radiated and conducted RF fields, magnetic fields and
power line transient requirements as mentioned in IEC 60601-1-2.
NOTE: For CE Compliance, it is critical that all covers, screws, shielding, gaskets, mesh, clamps, are in
good condition, installed tightly without skew or stress. Proper installation following all
comments noted in this service manual is required in order to achieve full EMC performance.
WARNING
WARNING Risk of electrical shock: System must be turned off.
!! WARNING:
Avoid all contact with electrical contacts, conductors and components.
Always use non-conductive handles designed for the removal and replacement of ESD
sensitive parts. All parts that have the potential for storing energy must be discharged
or isolated before making contact.
Section 1-5
Customer Assistance
1-5-1 Contact Information
If this equipment does not work as indicated in this service manual or in the Basic User Manual, or if
you require additional assistance, please contact the local distributor or appropriate support resource,
as listed below.
NOTE: Prepare vital system information (see: Section 7-2 on page 7-2) before you call:
• System Type
• System Serial number (also visible on label on back of the system)
• Application Software version
• Backup version
• additional information about installed software
USA
Service On-site 1-800–437–1171
GE Medical Systems
Service: Parts 1-800-558-2040
Ultrasound Service Engineering
9900 Innovation Drive (RP-2123)
Applications support 1-800-682-5327 or 1-262-524-5698
Wauwatosa, WI 53226, USA
Canada 1-800-668-0732
Service 1-800-321-7937
Latin America
Applications support 1-262-524-5698
GE Ultrasound Korea
9, Sunhwan-ro 214beon-gil, Jungwon-gu,
+82 (0) 31-740-6436
Seongnam-si, Gyeonggi-do,
Korea
Chapter 2
Site Preparation
Section 2-1
Overview
2-1-1 Purpose of Chapter 2
This chapter provides the information required to plan and prepare for the installation of a Voluson™S8
/ Voluson™S6 ultrasound unit. Included are descriptions of the facility and electrical needs to be met by
the purchaser.
Section 2-2
General Console Requirements
2-2-1 Environmental Requirements
Table 2-2 Environmental Requirements
CAUTION If the system has been in storage or has been transported, please see the acclimation requirements
!! CAUTION:
before powering ON and/or using the system (see: Section 3-2-2 "Installation Warnings" on page 3-3).
2-2-1-1 Cooling
The cooling requirement for the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 is 780/680 BTU/hr. This figure does not
include cooling needed for lights, people, or other equipment in the room.
NOTE: Each person in the room places an additional 300 BTU/hr. demand on the cooling system.
2-2-1-2 Lighting
Bright light is needed for system installation, updates and repairs. However, operator and patient
comfort may be optimized if the room light is subdued and indirect. Therefore a combination lighting
system (dim/bright) is recommended. Keep in mind that lighting controls and dimmers can be a source
of EMI which could degrade image quality. These controls should be selected to minimize possible
interference.
The dedicated line shall consist of one phase, a neutral (not shared with any other circuit), and a full
size Ground wire from the distribution panel to the Ultrasound outlet.
NOTE: Please note that image artifacts can occur, if at any time within the facility, the Ground from the main
facility's incoming power source to the Ultrasound unit is only a conduit.
NOTICE Possible EMI sources should be identified before the unit is installed.
!! NOTICE:
Electrical and electronic equipment may produce EMI unintentionally as the result of a defect.
Sources of EMI include the following:
• medical lasers
• scanners
• cauterizing guns
• computers
• monitors
• fans
• gel warmers
• microwave oven
• light dimmers
• portable phones
• broadcast stations and mobile broadcasting machines
Keep the unit at least 5 meters (16.4 feet) away from other EMI sources. Special shielding may be
Be aware of RF sources. required to eliminate interference problems caused by high frequency, high powered radio or video
broadcast signals.
Poor grounding is the most likely reason a unit will have noisy images.
Ground the unit.
Check grounding of the power cord and power outlet.
After you finish repairing or updating the system, replace all covers and tighten all screws.
Replace and/or reassemble
Any cable with an external connection requires a magnet wrap at each end.
all screws, RF gaskets,
Install the shield over the front of card cage. Loose or missing covers or RF gaskets allow radio
covers and cores.
frequencies to interfere with the ultrasound signals.
If more than 20% or a pair of the fingers on an RF gasket are broken, replace the gasket.
Replace broken RF gaskets.
Do not turn ON the unit until any loose metallic part is removed and replaced, if required.
Never place a label where RF gaskets meet the unit. Otherwise, the gap created will permit RF
Do not place labels where
leakage. In case a label has been found in such a location, move the label to a different,
RF gaskets touch metal.
appropriate location.
The interconnect cables are grounded and require ferrite beads and other shielding.
Use GE- specified
Cable length, material, and routing are all important; do not make any changes that do not meet
harnesses and peripherals.
all specifications.
Do not allow cables to lie across the top of the card cage or hang out of the peripheral bays.
Properly dress peripheral
Loop the excess length for peripheral cables inside the peripheral bays.
cables.
Attach the monitor cables to the frame.
NOTICE SYSTEMS AND ELECTRONIC PROBES ARE DESIGNED FOR STORAGE TEMPERATURES OF
!! NOTICE:
-10 TO + 50 degrees C. WHEN EXPOSED TO LARGE TEMPERATURE VARIATIONS, THE
PRODUCT SHOULD BE KEPT IN ROOM TEMPERATURE FOR 10 HOURS BEFORE USE.
CAUTION Have two people available to deliver and unpack the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 ultrasound
!! CAUTION:
system.
Attempts to move the unit considerable distances (or on an incline) by one person alone, could
result in personal injury and/or damage to the system.
NOTE: Physical dimensions (especially height and depth) depend on control console and monitor positioning.
For more details refer to Chapter 5 - OPIO Positioning, on page 5-46.
Table 2-5 Physical Dimensions and Weight (without Monitor and Peripherals)
* maximum at “normal” Monitor position (control console is elevated and moved forwards to the maximum)
** minimum at “normal” Monitor position (no control console elevation or forwards movement)
Section 2-3
Facility Needs
2-3-1 Purchaser Responsibilities
The work and materials needed to prepare the site is the responsibility of the purchaser. Delay,
confusion, and waste of manpower can be avoided by completing pre installation work before delivery.
Use the Pre-installation checklist (provided in Table 2-6) to verify that all needed steps have been taken.
Action Yes No
Notify installation team of the existence of any variances from the basic installation.
Make sure system and probes have been subject to acclimation period.
EMI precautions have been taken and all possible sources of interference have been removed.
If a network is used, IP address has been set for the system and a dedicated network outlet is available.
NOTE: All electrical installations that are preliminary to the positioning of the equipment at the site prepared for
the equipment must be performed by licensed electrical contractors. Other connections between pieces
of electrical equipment, calibrations, and testing must also be performed by qualified personnel.
The products involved (and the accompanying electrical installations) are highly sophisticated and
special engineering competence is required. All electrical work on these products must comply with the
requirements of applicable electrical codes. The purchaser of GE equipment must only utilize qualified
personnel to perform electrical servicing on the equipment.
The desire to use a non–listed or customer provided product or to place an approved product further
from the system than the interface kit allows presents challenges to the installation team. To avoid
delays during installation, such variances should be made known to the individuals or group performing
the installation at the earliest possible date (preferably prior to the purchase).
The ultrasound suite must be clean prior to delivery of the machine. Carpet is not recommended
because it collects dust and creates static. Potential sources of EMI (electromagnetic interference)
should also be investigated before delivery. Dirt, static, and EMI can negatively impact system reliability.
• A dedicated single branch power outlet of adequate amperage (see Table 2-3 on page 2-3) that
meets all local and national codes and is located less than 2.5 m (8.2 ft) from the unit’s proposed
location. Refer to: Section 2-2-2 "Electrical Requirements" on page 2-2.
• A door opening of at least 76 cm (2.5 ft) in width.
• The proposed location for the unit is at least 0.2 m (0.67 ft) from the walls, to enable cooling.
• Clean and protected space for storage of probes (either in their case or on a rack).
• Material to safely clean probes (performed using a plastic container, never metal).
• Power outlet and place for any external peripheral are within 2 m (6.5 ft.) of each other with
peripheral within 1 m of the unit to connect cables.
NOTE: The Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 has four outlets inside the unit. One is for the monitor and three for on
board peripherals.
NOTE: All relevant preliminary network port installations at the prepared site must be performed by authorized
contractors. The purchaser of GE equipment must utilize only qualified personnel to perform servicing
of the equipment.
Cabinet for
Software and Manuals
(optional)
35.5 IN.
(92 CM)
• Ethernet
• Wireless LAN
Use the Connectivity Setup Worksheet on page 3-90 to record required information that must include:
• Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 DICOM network details for the Voluson® unit, including the host
Details: name, local port, IP address, AE title and net mask.
• Routing Information: IP addresses for default gateway and other routers in use at site.
• DICOM Application Information: Details of DICOM devices in use at the site, including the DICOM
host name, AE title, DICOM port number and IP addresses.
Chapter 3
Setup Instructions
Section 3-1
Overview
3-1-1 The Purpose of Chapter 3
This chapter contains information needed to setup the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 ultrasound system.
Included are procedures to receive, unpack and configure the equipment.
A worksheet is provided (see: page 3-90 to page 3-91) to help ensure that all the required information
is available, prior to setup the system.
Section 3-2
Set Up Reminders
3-2-1 Average Installation Time
Once the site has been prepared, the average installation time required is shown in Table 3-2 below.
Table 3-2 Average Installation Time
CAUTION Equipment damage possibility. Turning the system on without acclimation after arriving at site
!! CAUTION:
may cause the system to be damaged.
hrs 10 8 6 4 2 0 0 0 0 0 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20
WARNING
WARNING The system should NOT be moved with the OPIO (User Interface) extended. Move the
!! WARNING:
OPIO to it’s centered and locked position. Refer to 4-7-1 on page 4-53.
WARNING
WARNING Monitor mounting mechanism may break if not properly supported (e.g., with packing
!! WARNING:
foam) during transportation.
Chapter 3 - Setup Instructions 3-3
GE RAFT VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 DRAFT (DECEMBER 12, 2017) BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
WARNING
WARNING REMEMBER: If the front wheel brakes are engaged for transportation, release brake
!! WARNING:
pedals (brakes on front wheels under the foot rest) to disengage the lock.
DANGER WHEN USING ANY TEST INSTRUMENT THAT IS CAPABLE OF OPENING THE
!! DANGER:
AC GROUND LINE (I.E., METER’S GROUND SWITCH IS OPEN), DO NOT
TOUCH THE UNIT!
CAUTION Two people should unpack the unit because of its weight.
!! CAUTION:
Two people are required whenever a part weighing 16kg (35 lb.) or more must be lifted.
CAUTION If the unit is very cold or hot, do NOT turn on its power until it has had sufficient time to
!! CAUTION:
acclimate to its operating environment.
CAUTION To prevent electrical shock, connect the unit to a properly grounded power outlet.
!! CAUTION:
DO NOT use a three to two prong adapter. This defeats safety grounding.
CAUTION DO NOT wear the ESD wrist strap when you work on live circuits and more than 30 V peak is
!! CAUTION:
present.
CAUTION DO NOT use a 20 Amp to 15 Amp adapter on the 120 Vac unit’s power cord.
!! CAUTION:
This unit requires a dedicated 16 A circuit.
CAUTION DO NOT operate this unit unless all board covers and frame panels are securely in place, to
!! CAUTION:
ensure optimal system performance and cooling.
(When covers are removed, EMI may be present).
Section 3-3
Receiving and Unpacking the Equipment
CAUTION Please read this section carefully before unpacking the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 ultrasound
!! CAUTION:
system and its (optional) peripherals.
The Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 ultrasound systemand accessories are shipped from the factory in a
single durable shipping carton which is mounted on a raised wooden platform base.
* Weight is approximate and will vary depending upon the supplied peripherals
Each shipping crate is sealed with cross-head screws. A Phillips 2 screwdriver is needed to open the
crate. It is recommended to keep and store the shipping crate and all other packing materials (includ-
ing the support foams, anti-static plastic cover, etc.), in case the unit has to be moved to a different
location. Unpack the devices such a way that packaging can be reused.
For warranty purposes, storage of the above is required for one year from date of purchase..
Step Task
1. Loosen the screws. DO NOT remove the top panel, just place it on the crate (about middle of side walls).
Step Task
2. Remove the top cover and top plate.
Step Task
5. Cut the tape to unfold the package and remove the antistatic vinyl cover
6. Disengage the brakes, grasp the system at the handle, then slowly move unit down the ramp.
Note: Packing crate and material should be stored for future use.
Section 3-4
Preparing for Set Up
3-4-1 Verify Customer Order
1.) After unpacking the equipment, it is important to verify that all items ordered by the customer have
been received. Compare all items listed on the packing slip (delivery note) with those received.
NOTICE It is recommended to keep and store the shipping carton and all other packing materials (including the
!! NOTICE:
support foams, anti-static plastic cover, etc.), in case the unit has to be moved to a different location.
Unpack the devices such a way that packaging can be reused.
For warranty purposes, storage of the above is required for one year from date of purchase.
2.) Visually inspect the system components using the following checklist.
2 Console Verify that the system is switched OFF and unplugged. Clean the console and control panel.
Check all probes for wear and tear on the lens, cable, and connector. Look for bent or damaged pins on the
4 Probes connector and in the connector socket on the unit. Verify that the EMI fingers around the probe connector
socket housing are intact. Check the probe locking mechanism and probe switch.
Clean the LCD display by gently wiping with a dry, soft, lint-free non-abrasive folded cloth. Inspect the monitor
5 LCD Display
for scratches and raster burn.
6 Fans Verify that the system’s cooling fans and peripheral fans are operating.
7 Check the rear panel connectors for bent pins, loose connections and loose or missing hardware. Screw all
Rear Panel
the cable connectors tightly to the connector sockets on the panel. Verify that the labeling is in good condition.
Check that all screws are tightly secured in place, that there are no dents or scratches and that no internal
8 Covers
parts are exposed.
Check and clean the peripherals in accordance with the manufacturer’s directions.
9 Peripherals
To prevent EMI or system overheating, dress the peripheral cables inside the peripheral cover.
10 Check the power cord for cuts, loose hardware, tire marks, exposed insulation, or any deterioration.
Power Cord
Verify continuity. Replace the power cord, as required.
NOTE: Report any items that are missing, back-ordered, or damaged, to your GE sales representative. The
contact address is shown in Contact Information on page 1-15.
WARNING
WARNING CONNECTING A Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 SCANNER TO THE WRONG VOLTAGE
!! WARNING:
LEVEL WILL MOST LIKELY DESTROY THE SCANNER.
this interference. For this reason, it is imperative that all covers and hardware are installed and secured
before the unit is put into operation.
Ensure that the system is protected from electromagnetic interference (EMI), as follows:
• Operate the system at least 15 feet away from equipment that emits strong electromagnetic
radiation.
• Operate the system in an area enclosed by walls, floors and ceilings comprised of wood, plaster or
concrete, which help prevent EMI.
• Shield the system when operating it in the vicinity of radio broadcast equipment, if necessary.
• Do not operate mobile phones or other EMI emitting devices in the ultrasound room.
• Verify that all EMI rules listed in the following table are followed:
The Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 ultrasound unit is approved for use in hospitals, clinics and other
environmentally qualified facilities, in terms of the prevention of radio wave interference. Operation of
the ultrasound unit in an inappropriate environment can cause electronic interference to radios and
television sets situated near the medical equipment.
For further details and EMI Prevention/Abatement refer to Section 2-2-3 "EMI Limitations" on page 2-4.
Section 3-5
Connection of Auxiliary Devices
NOTE: Normally auxiliary devices and peripherals come pre-installed with the system.
Table 3-7 below outlines hardware installation procedures described in the sub-sections.
Table 3-7 Connection Procedures
3-5-9 General Remarks and Hints when using external USB-Devices 3-23
WARNING
WARNING After each installation, the leakage currents have to be measured according to
!! WARNING:
IEC 60601-1 respectively UL 60601-1.
CAUTION Please observe that some printers may not be medical devices! If the Bluetooth Printer and/or
!! CAUTION:
Line Printers are not medical devices, they have to be located outside of the patient
environment (according to IEC 60601-1 / UL 60601-1).
1,5 m
2,5 m
1,5 m 1,5 m
NOTE: For more detailed Safety Considerations when connecting auxiliary devices to the Voluson™S8 /
Voluson™S6 system, please review: Chapter 1 - Auxiliary Devices Safety, on page 1-8.
1.) Power OFF/Shutdown the system as described in: Section 3-6-3 on page 3-29.
2.) Connect the Black & White printer according to correct connection scheme as described in
Figure 3-6 on page 3-15
NOTE: The Black & White printer should be connected to the USB2 port of the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6´s
PC-part.
3.) When all the cables are connected, press the Power ON switch on the Black & White printer.
4.) Power ON/Boot up the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 system as described in Section 3-6-2 on page
3-25. All software drivers are pre-installed for the designated Black & White printer only.
5.) After physical connection to the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 system, assign the printer to a remote
key (P1, P2, P3 and/or P4) as described in Section 3-7-6 "Remote Control Selection" on page 3-55.
6.) Verify the correct settings in the printer “Properties”, see: Section 3-7-5 "Adjustment of Printer
Settings" on page 3-48.
WARNING
WARNING After each installation, the leakage currents have to be measured according to
!! WARNING:
IEC 60601-1 respectively UL 60601-1.
1.) Power OFF/Shutdown the system as described in: Section 3-6-3 on page 3-29.
2.) Connect the Color printer according to correct connection scheme as described in Figure 3-7 on
page 3-17.
NOTE: The Color printer should be connected to the USB1 port of the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6´s PC-part.
3.) When all the cables are connected, press the Power ON switch on the Color printer.
4.) Power ON/Boot up the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 system as described in Section 3-6-2 on page
3-25. All software drivers are pre-installed for the designated Color printer only.
5.) After physical connection to the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 system, assign the printer to a remote
key (P1, P2, P3 and/or P4) as described in Section 3-7-6 "Remote Control Selection" on page 3-55.
6.) Verify the correct settings in the printer “Properties”, see: Section 3-7-5 "Adjustment of Printer
Settings" on page 3-48.
WARNING
WARNING After each installation, the leakage currents have to be measured according to
!! WARNING:
IEC 60601-1 respectively UL 60601-1.
Figure 3-8 HP Officejet H470 DeskJet Printer connection (via Bluetooth Adapter)
CAUTION Please observe that the complete Bluetooth Printer Assembly has to be located outside of the
!! CAUTION:
patient environment (according to IEC 60601-1 / UL 60601-1).
CAUTION The printer being used may not be a medical device. The Bluetooth Printer Set and the Power
!! CAUTION:
Supply of the Bluetooth Printer Adapter is also not a medical device.
The equipment meets the requirements of the EN 60950 Standard.
1.) Turn ON the power of the system and wait till the system has booted.
2.) Plug the Wireless Network adapter into an accessible USB port of the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6.
All software drivers are pre-installed for the designated Wireless Network adapter only.
NOTE: After physical connection of the WLAN adapter to the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 system, follow the
procedure described in Section 3-12-2 "Wireless Network Configuration" on page 3-77.
The USB Flash Memory Stick may be connected to an accessible USB port of the Voluson™S8 /
Voluson™S6 system (e.g., on back of control console).
An external USB Flash Memory Stick can be connected once the system is powered ON, or after
shutdown. The Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6, Windows detects the device and automatically installs a
driver. During this process several dialogs may pop up, starting with the „Found New Hardware” dialog.
NOTICE Before disconnecting an external USB-device (e.g., USB Stick), the system has to be informed about
!! NOTICE:
the removal of the device! For this purpose press the F3 button on the keyboard.
For further details refer to: Section 3-5-9-2 "External USB-Devices - Disconnection" on page 3-23.
The external “Handydrive” HDD may be connected to an accessible USB port of the Voluson™S8 /
Voluson™S6 system (e.g., on back of control console).
An external USB Hard Disk Drive can be connected once the system is powered ON, or after shutdown.
The Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6, Windows detects the device and automatically installs a driver.
During this process several dialogs may pop up, starting with the „Found New Hardware“ dialog.
NOTICE Before disconnecting an external USB-device (e.g., USB Hard disk), the system has to be informed
!! NOTICE:
about the removal of the device! For this purpose press the F3 button on the keyboard.
For further details refer to: Section 3-5-9-2 "External USB-Devices - Disconnection" on page 3-23.
NOTE: If an external drive was not recognized automatically after connecting it, click RESCAN DRIVE.
The device is then accessible using the drive letter the system assigned to it.
NOTICE When connecting external USB devices, be sure to execute Safety Directions found in the
!! NOTICE:
Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Basic User Manual.
Before an external USB-device (e.g., USB-memory stick) can be disconnected, the system has to be
informed about the removal of the device!
CAUTION Unplugging or ejecting USB devices without first stopping them can often cause the system to
!! CAUTION:
crash and possibly result in loss of valuable data.
By pressing the DRIVES in the Sytem Setup, a dialog window (see: Figure 3-11 below) is displayed.
The “Connect USB and Network Drives” window shows all USB and Network drives connected to the
system. Using this dialog, the USB-devices can be stopped before they are physically disconnected.
To stop the external device, select it and then click the STOP DEVICE button.
Confirm the ‘Stop Device‘ dialog with OK the “Connect USB and Network Drives” window.
Section 3-6
Completing the Set Up
3-6-1 Connecting the Unit to a Power Source
The connection of the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 ultrasound unit to a power source should be
performed by a qualified person who has completed basic Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 System User
Training. Use only the power cords, cables and plugs provided by or designated by GE to connect the
unit to the power source.
CAUTION Prior to connect the Voluson® unit to a power source, verify compliance with all electrical and
!! CAUTION:
safety requirements. Check the power cord to verify that it is intact and of hospital-grade.
Products equipped with a power source (wall outlet) plug should be connected to the fixed
power socket that has a protective grounding conductor. Never use an adapter or converter to
connect with a power source plug (for example, a three-prong to two-prong converter).
WARNING
WARNING The unit’s power must be supplied from a separate, properly rated outlet to avoid risk
!! WARNING:
of fire. Refer to Section 2-2-2-1 "Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Power Requirements" on
page 2-3 for rating information. The power cord should not, under any circumstances,
be altered to a configuration rated less than that specified for the current.
CAUTION Whenever disconnecting the Voluson® system from the electrical outlet, always observe the
!! CAUTION:
safety precautions. First unplug the main power cable from the wall outlet socket, then from the
unit itself. Remove by pulling on the cable connector - DO NOT pull on the cable.
Circuit
Main Power
NOTICE When AC power is applied to the scanner, the ON/OFF button on the control panel illuminates amber,
!! NOTICE:
indicating that the System (including the Back-end Processor) is in Standby mode.
4.) Hold down the On/Off button (see: Figure 3-14) on the control panel for ~3 seconds.
NOTE: The mains outlet of the system for peripheral auxiliary equipment are commonly switched with the
ON/OFF button. The power switch of any attached printer(s) needs to be in ON position before starting
the system. However, be aware some auxiliary equipment may switch itself to standby mode
(e.g., Color video printer) and must therefore be switched on separately.
When the ON/OFF button on the control panel is pressed, the System (including the Back-end
Processor) starts and the operating system is loaded which then leads the application software to
activate the scanner.
The system automatically performs an initialization sequence which includes the following:
On/Off Button
As soon as the software has been loaded, the system enters 2D-Mode with the probe and application
that were used before the system was shut down.
6.) The software initiates and sets up the Front-End electronics and the rest of the scanner.
7.) The Keyboard backlight is lit.
8.) As soon as the software has been loaded, the 2D screen is displayed on the monitor.
3.) Select the SHUTDOWN button. The system performs an automatic full shutdown sequence.
NOTE: Full shut down is also performed when pressing the ON/OFF button on the control panel twice.
NOTE: The mains outlet of the system for peripheral auxiliary equipment are commonly switched with the
ON/OFF button. So the auxiliary equipment need not to be switched ON/OFF separately.
WARNING
WARNING Disconnection of the Main Power Cable is necessary!
!! WARNING:
For Example: When repairing the system.
5.) After complete power down, disconnect the main power cable from the system or unplug it from the
AC wall outlet socket.
Circuit
Main Power
CAUTION DO NOT disconnect a probe while running (Live Scan “Write” mode)!
!! CAUTION:
A software error may occur. In this case switch the unit OFF (perform a reset).
1.) Inspect the probe and probe socket to verify that it is free of debris.
2.) Ensure that the probe locking lever is at left position, as shown Figure 3-19.
3.) Insert the connector on the receptacle, and move lever to the right position to lock probe.
Transducer Transducer
locked unlocked
(locking lever in (locking lever in
right position) left position)
4.) Carefully position the probe cord so that it is free to move and is not resting on the floor.
CAUTION Do not bend the probe cable acutely. Fault conditions can result in electric shock hazard.
!! CAUTION:
Do not touch the surface of probe connectors which are exposed when the probe is removed.
Do not touch the patient when connecting or disconnecting a probe.
Section 3-7
Printer Installation
NOTE: For Connection schemes refer to Section 3-5 "Connection of Auxiliary Devices" on page 3-12.
• Section 3-7-1 "Installing Digital Black & White Printer Sony UP-D898" on page 3-32
• Section 3-7-2 "Installing Digital Color Printer Sony UP-D25MD" on page 3-32
• Section 3-7-3 "Installing the Bluetooth Deskjet Printer" on page 3-33
• Section 3-7-4 "Printer Installation manually" on page 3-44
• Section 3-7-5 "Adjustment of Printer Settings" on page 3-48
CAUTION The Bluetooth Printer Connection set as well as the Color Deskjet printer MUST NOT be installed
!! CAUTION:
by the user!
For installation please contact your local distributor or GE service representative.
NOTICE After boot up of the system, verify the correct settings in the printer “Properties”,
!! NOTICE:
see: Section 3-7-5 "Adjustment of Printer Settings" on page 3-48.
Afterwards assign the Printer to the remote keys P1, P2, P3 and/or P4,
see: Section 3-7-6 "Remote Control Selection" on page 3-55.
NOTICE After boot up of the system, verify the correct settings in the printer “Properties”,
!! NOTICE:
see: Section 3-7-5 "Adjustment of Printer Settings" on page 3-48.
Afterwards assign the Printer to the remote keys P1, P2, P3 and/or P4,
see: Section 3-7-6 "Remote Control Selection" on page 3-55.
NOTE: "Mouse functions" can be performed by using the trackball for moving the cursor.
"Normal select" (Click) = left/right trackball key; "Opening a context menu" = upper trackball key
3-7-3-1 Installing the USB Bluetooth Adapter and the Bluetooth Software
1.) Turn ON the system and wait till the system has booted.
2.) Connect the USB "standard GE" service dongle to the USB connector(s) on the rear of the system.
As soon as the dongle is detected the login window pops up. Remove the dongle.
3.) Enter the "Standard GE Revolving" password (changes every six months) and then click ENABLE.
4.) Press the ALT + F4 key again to close the Ultrasound Application.
5.) Open the Windows Start menu by pressing CTRL + ESC on the keyboard, click on "WinExplorer"
and navigate to R:\system\periph\HP_Officejet_100\Bluetooth\WinXP.
Figure 3-20 select “WinExplorer” and double click the “Voluson_Bluetooth_Driver.exe” file
7.) Confirm the following dialog window with NEXT. The "License Agreement" window appears:
8.) Select "I accept the terms in the license agreement" and then click on NEXT.
9.) Confirm the following dialog with NEXT. The "Ready to Install the Program" window appears.
10.)Click on INSTALL.
The sytem starts Bluetooth software installation.
11.)When the dialog "Bluetooth device not found" appears, DO NOT click any button, simply move it
away.
Figure 3-23 “Bluetooth device not found” - DO NOT click any button
12.)Connect the Bluetooth Adapter (Belkin or DBT-122, Delock 61889) to USB port E (see: Figure 3-8
on page 3-18) on the rear side.
NOTE: If dialog "You must restart your system..." appears, click on YES to restart the system.
NOTE: All software drivers are pre-installed for the designated printer only, see Table 3-9 on page 3-70.
If the Bluetooth device is already up and running, you can see it in the Device Manager; see Figure 3-
39 on page 3-44 . In this case, skip installation of the Bluetooth Adapter, close all open windows and
proceed with Section 3.6.4.2 "Prepare the DeskJet Color Printer" on page 3-45.
14.)Open the Windows Start menu by pressing CTRL + ESC on the keyboard, and click Run.
15.)Type devmgmt.msc.
16.)Now you should see the installed Bluetooth device in the Device Manager. Click the right trackball
key and verify its device status: "This device is working properly."
6.) In the following window, enter an unique computer name (e.g., D10013 = Serial number of the
system) and then click NEXT.
enter an unique
computer name
NOTE: Display of this window might be different. It depends on installed Bluetooth Adapter.
3-7-3-3 Prepare the Printer and connect the Bluetooth Printer Adapter
NOTICE Preparations as well as Printer Adapter connection depend on the used Bluetooth Line Printer.
!! NOTICE:
NOTE: When the Bluetooth adapter is properly attached to the printer, the Power lamp will flash on.
NOTICE Be sure that during installation only the ultrasound system dedicated Bluetooth printer is powered on!
!! NOTICE:
1.) Press CTRL+ ESC to open the Start menu and open "My Bluetooth Places" (see: Figure 3-26).
2.) Select "View or modify configuration".
3.) In the LOCAL SERVICE page select "Printer" and click on PROPERTITES.
4.) Remove check mark at "Secure Connection" and then click OK.
Figure 3-33 "Local Services" page / remove check mark at "Secure Connection"
5.) In the CLIENT APPLICATIONS page select "Printer" and then click on PROPERTIES.
6.) Remove check mark at "Secure Connection" and then click OK.
11.)The appearance of the “Bluetooth Security Setup” window (Figure 3-36 below) depends on your
printer.
a.) If it looks like the left image, click on SKIP.
b.) If it looks like the right image, enter the passkey (0000) and then click on NEXT.
a.) b.)
13.)If the "Add Printer Wizard" window appears, select the HAVE DISK button.
14.)Use the BROWSE button to search the printer driver on R:\system\periph\xxx and then click OPEN.
NOTE: Almost all Printer drivers (depends on software version) can also be found on R:\systems\periph\xxx.
15.)Verify the selected Printer Driver path and confirm with OK.
16.)Select manufacturer and model of your printer (e.g., HP Officejet H470 series BT) and click OK.
- DeskJet Color Printer (HP Officejet H470, HP Officejet 100) : proceed with Section 3-7-3-
5-1 on page 3-43
3-7-3-5-1 DeskJet Color Printer (HP Officejet H470, HP Officejet 100) - Printer Properties
After driver installation, the “HP Officejet H470 series BT Properties” and “HP Officejet 100 Mobile
L411” page appears.
3.) Close all open windows by clicking on the [x] sign in the corner, APPLY and/or OK.
4.) Open the Windows Start menu by pressing CTRL + ESC on the keyboard, click on
“WinExplorer” and navigate to R:\system\periph\xxx.
5.) Disable balloon tips by double-clicking the “DisableBalloonTips.reg” file.
[Add Printer]
button
Foot Switch
Remote Control
Report Printer
selection
4.) Click the ADD PRINTER button (see: Figure 3-41 above).
Please read the displayed message carefully and click YES if you have skills to do this.
5.) Click the NEXT button to start the Add Printer Wizard.
6.) Select the ‘Local Printer‘, deselect “Automatically install Plug and Play printer” and then click NEXT.
9.) Use the BROWSE button to search the Printer Driver path (R:\system\periph\xxxx).
10.)Click OPEN, select the “xxx.inf” file and click OPEN again.
11.)Verify the selected Printer Driver path and confirm with OK.
12.)Select the manufacturer and model of your printer and confirm with the NEXT button.
NOTE: If the “Printer Sharing” window appears, select ‘Do not share this printer‘ and confirm with NEXT.
14.)The “Complete the Add Printer Wizard” window appears on the screen.
NOTE: If the message “The software you are installing for this hardware has not passed Windows ....” appears,
click CONTINUE ANYWAY.
16.)Close all open windows, close the “System Setup” with SAVE & EXIT and restart the system
(turn off and on the system).
NOTICE After boot up of the system, verify the correct settings in the printer “Properties”,
!! NOTICE:
see: Section 3-7-5 "Adjustment of Printer Settings" on page 3-48.
Afterwards assign the Printer to the remote keys P1, P2, P3 and/or P4,
see: Section 3-7-6 "Remote Control Selection" on page 3-55.
To adjust the UP-D898 printer see: Section 3-7-5-1 "UP-D898 - Printer Settings"
To adjust the P95D printer see: Section 3-7-5-2 "P95D - Printer Settings" .
To adjust the UP-D25MD Printer see: Section 3-7-5-3 "UP-D25MD - Printer Settings"
WARNING
WARNING After each printer installation, the leakage currents have to be measured
!! WARNING:
acc. IEC 60601-1 resp. UL 60601-1.
3.) Select the DENSITY ADJUST page (see: Figure 3-50 above) and select:
- Gamma: TONE2
- Advanced = 0; Dark = 0; Light = 0 ; Sharpness = 2
4.) For saving the adjusted printer settings click APPLY and then OK.
Finally close the ‘Printers’ -window with the close button and exit System Setup with SAVE&EXIT.
5.) Assign the Printer to the remote keys P1, P2, P3 and/or P4 with the save button;
see: Section 3-7-6 "Remote Control Selection" on page 3-55.
5.) For saving the adjusted printer settings click APPLY and then OK.
Finally close the ‘Printers’ -window with the close button and exit System Setup with SAVE&EXIT.
6.) Assign the Printer to the remote keys P1, P2, P3 and/or P4 with the save button;
see: Section 3-7-6 "Remote Control Selection" on page 3-55.
NOTICE Settings for Paper Size MUST match with the used Paper (large/small) and also the right color ink
!! NOTICE:
cartridge has to be used. Otherwise you will get an error message at printing.
4.) For saving the adjusted printer settings click APPLY and then OK.
Finally close the ‘Printers’-window with the close button and exit System Setup with SAVE&EXIT.
5.) Assign the Printer to the remote keys P1, P2, P3 and/or P4 with the save button; see: Section 3-7-
6 on page 3-55.
Configure
buttons
Overview
Select
Detailed Setup Printer
Recorder
Control
• Overview tab:
- Configure “Remote” Buttons: Select the desired remote control button.
- Select Printer: Check mark and select the desired Printer for the remote control button.
- Recorder Control: Check mark this item to use the selected P? key for Recorder Control.
NOTE: Optionally the Printer Remote Control can be done by the Foot switch.
(refer to: Figure 3-41: System Setup - Connectivity - PERIPHERALS page on page 3-44)
NOTICE The selected Report Printer is usually used for printing reports and images from the Archive.
!! NOTICE:
Figure 3-58
Figure 3-59
Figure 3-60
Figure 3-61
Figure 3-62
2.) Slide up the upper cover of the Cellular Modem(POS.1) to get access to the SIM card holder.
Figure 3-63
3.) Put in the SIM card like it is shown in the picture below, fix the SIM card with the mounted clips and
put back on the upper cover.
Figure 3-64
4.) Combine loop fastener and hook fastener. And detach sticker from hook fastener like below
picture(Make two pair).
Figure 3-65
Figure 3-66
6.) Refer to cellular modem guide and attach cellular modem to rear cover like below.
Figure 3-67
7.) Plug Power cable and USB Cable(to port 3) for cellular modem like below picture.
Figure 3-68
8.) Refer to below picture, insert two cable*USB and Power for cellular modem) through hole of EMI
cover.
Figure 3-69
Figure 3-70
10.)Pull out two cables from CABLE COVER BRKT POLARIS. First, pull out power cable within the
limits of the possible. Thereafter, pull out USB cable like below picture. To align cable edge, pull out
USB cable as much as power cable.
Figure 3-71
Figure 3-72
Figure 3-73
3-62 Section 3-8 - Cellular Modem Installation
GE DRAFT VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 DRAFT (DECEMBER 12, 2017) BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
The Cellular Modem is useful if no Internet connection is available via LAN or WIFI. Connecting the
Voluson S6S8/P6P8 Series th the Internet allows the user to send images via e-mail and/or MMS to
patients or physicians.
NOTE: MMS are sent by e-mail to a 3rd party provider(e.g. SMS global). This service needs to be ordered
bt a 3rd party provider.
NOTE: Please check with a Smartphone located near the Voluson S6S8/P6P8 Series, if netword coverage
is available. Used SIM card in the Smartphone should use same provider as SIM card for Cellular
Modem.
Hardware Setup: To use the feature the peripheral Cellular Modem needs to be installed and a SIM card
from your local service provider needs to be ordered.
• Data capable
• Standard size
• Prepaid or post paid
NOTE: Since the Voluson S6S8/P6P8 Series does not enable browser access, the service provider needs
to enable the Internet access on the SIM card before installation in the Cellular Modem. Please
ensure from the service provider, that there is no browser registration necessary when using the
SIM card.
Dial in phone Number e.g., *99# - if not explicitly stated by the provider, use *99#
Please ensure that the SIM card information is available before setting up the Voluson S6S8/P6P8
Series.
Password: ppp
Figure 3-74
Section 3-9
System Configuration
3-9-1 System Setup
Modifications of system parameters and settings are supported by 4 major groups.
Each major group contains diverse dialog pages and sub windows.
• General: Date, Time, Clinic Name, (EUM) Language, Screen saver, etc.
• User Settings: to save User programs, 3D/4D programs, Auto Text, Doppler 2D Refresh, etc.
• Patient Info Display: Drop Down Management, Capitalize Letter in Patient Names, etc.
• Service tab: conncet the USB “standard GE” dongle and enter the “standard GE revolving”
password (change every six months_ to get access to the Service Tools functions.
• System Info: shows which Software/Hardware version is installed in the system
• Options: shows which options are installed in the system
For information on configuring Software Options refer to Section 8-7 on page 8-22
• Peripherals: Video Norm selection, Foot switch assignment, Add Printer, Edit Printer settings, etc.
• Device Setup: to set up all DICOM, Archive and Network configuration nodes
• Button Configuration: to adjust assignment of Remote keys P1, P2, P3 and P4,... (e.g, Printer
selection)
• Drives: USB and Network drives: stop devices, map network drive, Erase CD
• System Configuration: Save/Load Settings only, Save/Load/Delete Full System Configuration
• Image Archive: to save or load Image Archive
NOTICE More detailed information pertaining System Setup adjustments is found in the Basic User Manual; see:
!! NOTICE:
Table 9-10, “System Manuals - Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6,” on page 9-18.
In general operations are done with the trackball and the trackball keys (mouse emulation).
select
Date Format
select
Display
Time Format
options
Date/Time
and Time Zone
change
Clinic Name Language
NOTE: A new screen lock password must be at least 6 characters long and has a maximum length of 80
characters. The password must contain at least 2 non-letter characters, 0...9 or !@#$%^*().
c.) “Retype new Password” and then click SAVE&EXIT to save new screen lock password.
4.) Click SAVE&EXIT to save Settings and exit System Setup.
NOTE: If screen is locked you have to enter the password to get full system control.
If password is unknown click EMERGENCY. This enables standard - but limited - operation.
NOTICE The Screen Lock password cannot be reset by the user! Please contact your GE service representative.
!! NOTICE:
Foot
Switch
3.) Select desired function of the Footswitch Left, Middle and Right.
4.) Click SAVE&EXIT to save Settings and exit System Setup.
NOTICE Parameters and possible adjustments mostly depend on the selected Application!
!! NOTICE:
• Measure & Calc - shows all settings, which are used for generic measurements as well as
calculations in different applications
• Application Parameters - to adjust: status on freeze for different modes, Manual Trace method,
Calculation Ratio, etc.
• Global Parameters - to select: if the measurement results should be deleted (= Yes), or kept on
screen (= No) as soon as cine mode is activated, cursor type and size, Font size and color of
measure results, position of measure results for different modes, etc.
NOTICE More detailed information pertaining Measure Setup adjustments is found in the Basic User Manual of
!! NOTICE:
the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6;
see: Table 9-10, “System Manuals - Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6,” on page 9-18.
In general operations are done with the trackball and the trackball keys (mouse emulation).
Drawer GEUK
1 3
2 NETWORK Table 3-13 DICOM input/output, twisted pair RJ-45 10/100 megabit/s
13 CEC CEC
14 N/C Reserved
17 DDC/CEC/HEC DDC/CEC/HEC
18 5V Power
Others NC No connection
Section 3-10
Available Probes
See Chapter 9 - Probes, on page 9-19, for part numbers to be used when ordering new or replacement
service probes.
Section 3-11
Software/Option Configuration
For description refer to:
NOTICE More detailed information pertaining System Setup and Measure Setup adjustments is found in the
!! NOTICE:
Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Basic User Manual, which is available in different languages.
Section 3-12
Connectivity Setup
The Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 ultrasound system can be connected to various connectivity devices.
The following sections describe how to connect the system to a remote archive/work station or a DICOM
service, using a TCP/IP connection.
Patient information can include demographic data and images, as well as reports and Measurement
and Analysis (M&A) data.
A dataflow is a set of pre-configured services. Selecting a dataflow will automatically customize the
ultrasound unit to work according to the services associated with this dataflow.
By utilizing data flows, the user can configure the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 ultrasound unit to
optimally meet the needs of the facility, while keeping the user interface unchanged. Once the dataflow
is selected, the actual location of the database is entirely transparent.
PC with 4D View
A remote database is used for patient archiving.
Images are also stored to a remote archive.
For Image Management functionality refer to the Basic User Manual of the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6.
NOTICE To avoid loss of essential data, it is highly recommended to export/backup patient data as well as
!! NOTICE:
measurements at least once a month.
Physical Connection:
The images are first stored on the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 scanner’s hard drive (Archive) and then
exported from the scanner’s hard drive to a sneaker device (e.g., DVD/CD), and finally imported from
the sneaker device to the “4D View” PC’s internal hard drive.
For Image Management functionality refer to the Basic User Manual of the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6.
NOTICE To avoid loss of essential data, it is highly recommended to export/backup patient data as well as
!! NOTICE:
measurements at least once a month.
Physical Connection:
Physical Connection:
1.) Connect one end of the cable to the Ethernet connector on the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6.
2.) Connect the other end of the cable to the wall outlet.
NOTE: If a Peer-to-Peer Network is connected to the hospital’s network, you may connect the
Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 to the Peer-to-Peer Network.
For more details refer to Section 3-13 "Network IP Address Configuration" on page 3-80.
NOTICE To configure the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 ultrasound unit to work with WLAN, the hospital’s
!! NOTICE:
network administrator has to provide the required information.
1.) Connect the Wireless Network adapter as described in Section 3-5-5 on page 3-20.
2.) Press the UTILITIES key on the control panel and select SYSTEM SETUP to invoke setup desktop.
3.) On the left side of the screen select CONNECTIVITY and then click the DEVICE SETUP tab.
4.) Click the WLAN CONFIGURATION button.
[WLAN Configuration]
button
[Country]
Pull-down Menu
NOTE:
This example shows
fictional information!
SSID
Wireless Security
Type
[Find a Network]
button
6.) Enter “Network Name (SSID)” and check/adjust all other settings.
NOTE: For detailed description of available parameters, refer to Section 3-12-2-1 "Description of “Netgear”
Configuration Parameters" on page 3-79.
7.) Type a suitable name for the new profile into the “Profiles” box and then click SAVE PROFILE.
8.) Finally click FIND NETWORK and wait a few seconds....
After a few seconds waiting, following information appear in the status bar at the bottom of the page.
You have successfully installed WLAN, are connected to a wireless network and ready to communicate!
connection status icon Network Name Network security WLAN current signal strength
“ready to communicate” (SSID) (locked/unlocked) transfer rate of the wireless network
CAUTION WLAN security has to be adjusted to prevent viruses and to ensure data protection. Discuss
!! CAUTION:
settings with the hospital´s network administrator. He must provide the required information.
Chapter 3 - Setup Instructions 3-79
GE RAFT VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 DRAFT (DECEMBER 12, 2017) BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
Section 3-13
Network IP Address Configuration
NOTE: Following Information must be provided by customer or hospital engineer before you can start:
A Station name, AE Title, IP address and Port Number for the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6.
The IP addresses for the default gateway and other routers at the site for ROUTING INFORMATION.
Only if necessary (e.g. for Internet access).
To specify a DICOM Address, follow the instructions of described in the Basic User Manual,
Chapter 13 of the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6.
3-80 Section 3-13 - Network IP Address Configuration
GE DRAFT VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 DRAFT (DECEMBER 12, 2017) BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
4.) Select the MAP NETWORK DRIVE button to open a dialog where the system can be connected to
a shared network drive of another server.
NOTICE The MAP NETWORK DRIVE button is also accessible in the “Connect USB and Network Drives” dialog
!! NOTICE:
window that appears when pressing the EJECT (= F3) key on the alphanumeric keyboard.
5.) Enter the name of the shared network folder in the „Network Folder Name” field.
6.) Supply a valid user name and a password for this folder.
NOTE: If you check the „Automatic Reconnect“ box, the system tries to establish the connection
again when starting up.
Otherwise, the connection must be re-established manually after a shutdown or reboot.
NOTICE If there is an error during the connection, a warning message appears inside the dialog.
!! NOTICE:
In this case, please verify the data in the dialog.
NOTICE If there already is a connection to the remote server, the CONNECT button is grayed.
!! NOTICE:
To change the existing connection, first click on DISCONNECT and then enter the new settings.
WARNING
WARNING Please make sure that the server you are connecting to is trustworthy and reliable.
!! WARNING:
For details, contact your local system administrator.
If you backup Archive data to this server, all the patients’ demographic data will be
copied to this server!
By means of the Cellular Modem, it is possible to connect the Voluson S6S8/P6P8 Series to the Internet
by using a SIM card.
The Cellular Modem is useful if no Internet connection is available via LAN or WIFI. Connecting the
Voluson S6S8/P6P8 Series to the Internet allows the user to send images via e-mail and/or MMS to
patients or physicians.
NOTE: MMS are sent by e-mail to a 3rd party provider (e.g. SMSglobal). This service needs to be ordered by
a 3rd party provider.
NOTE: Please check with a Smartphone located near the Voluson S6S8/P6P8 Series, if network coverage is
available. Used SIM card in the Smartphone should use same provider as SIM card for Cellular Modem.
Hardware Setup: To use the feature the peripheral Cellular Modem needs to be installed and a SIM card
from your local service provider needs to be ordered.
• Data capable
• Standard size
• prepaid or post paid
NOTE: Since the Voluson S6S8/P6P8 Series does not enable browser access, the service provider needs to
enable the Internet access on the SIM card before installation in the Cellular Modem. Please ensure
from the service provider, that there is no browser registration necessary when using the SIM card.
Dial in Phone Number e.g., *99# - if not explicitly stated by the provider, use *99#
Please ensure that the SIM card information is available before setting up the Voluson S6S8/
P6P8 Series.
Modem Configuration
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in Section 3-6-3 on page 3-29 .
2.) Insert the SIM card into the Cellular Modem.
3.) Connect the Cellular Modem as described.
4.) Press the Utilities key on the control console.
5.) In the “Utilities” menu touch the Setup button to invoke the setup desktop on the screen.
6.) On the right side of the screen select Connectivity and then click the Device Setup tab.
7.) Click the Modem Configuration button; see Figure 3-89 on page 3-84 .
The Modem Configuration screen appear.
NOTE: Please keep the Dial information as *99#. Only in seldom cases different Dial information is needed.
If the connection is not established: Tooltip of the status icon provides an error message.
13.)Depending on the region and/or provider it might be possible that you need one time registration of
your SIM card, therefore:
To enable E-mail, the SMTP (Simple Mail Transfer Protocol) settings from your provider are needed.
The Voluson S6S8/P6P8 Series is only supporting E-mail send; no e-mail receive is possible. To
receive reply E-mails, the same E-mail account needs to be installed on an Office-PC.
NOTE: Maybe the information above needs to be searched in the Internet from your e-mail provider and is the
same for all e-mail users.
Email Configuration
5.) Enter Your name and Email Address in the Identity group. As an option you can enter a different
Reply to Address and a Signature Text.
6.) To verify E-mail configuration click on Send Test Email. An E-mail is sent to the entered E-mail
address followed by a message box where either a success message or an error message is
shown.
7.) Store your configuration with click on OK.
8.) If it is desired to use also MMS, adjust settings as described in Section 3-13-4 on page 3-87 .
9.) Individually enter Patient's Email address and Phone number in the PID screen and adjust Email
and/or MMS options as described in Section 3-13-3 on page 3-86 .
3-86 Section 3-13 - Network IP Address Configuration
GE DRAFT VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 DRAFT (DECEMBER 12, 2017) BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
NOTE: MMS are sent by e-mail to a 3rd party provider (e.g. SMSglobal). This service needs to be ordered by
a 3rd party provider.
To use the MMS feature you need to contract with a 3rd party provider which offers E-mail to MMS
service (e.g. SMSglobal). Please contact the service provider!
Voluson S6S8/P6P8 Series sends an E-mail with an attached image to the E-mail to MMS service. The
MMS phone number is encapsulated in the recipient E-mail address
MMS Options
6.) Enter the Domain Name from 3rd party E-mail to MMS service.
Note: An E-mail to phone number@Domain Name for MMS Email is sent!
3-13-5 How to enter Patient's Email address and Phone number in the PID screen
1.) Enter the “Patient ID” screen by pressing the Patient ID key on the control console.
2.) Click the @ icon (1).
The Patient’s Email address and Phone number window appear.
NOTE: Since the E-mail to MMS service provider is maybe not located in the same area as your MMS
receptions, you need to add the area code (e.g. +49 or 0049 for Germany) to the used phone numbers
in the Patient's E-mail address and Phone number dialog.
Example: local phone number 069913800000 is +49 69913800000 or 0049 69913800000 for Germany
Section 3-14
Connectivity Setup Worksheet
Dept: Room:
Voluson™S8
/ Type: REV:
CONTACT INFORMATION
Name Title Phone E-Mail Address
Name - AE Title:
System IP Settings IP Address:
Name - AE Title:
Subnet Mask:
IP Address:
Default Gateway:
Subnet Mask:
Server Name:
Default Gateway:
Remote DB User Name:
Voluson™S8
/
Host Name Local Port IP Address . . .
ROUTER1 . . . . . .
ROUTER2 . . . . . .
ROUTER3 . . . . . .
Store 1 . . .
Store 2 . . .
Store 3D_1 . . .
Store 3D_2 . . .
Print . . .
Worklist . . .
Structured
. . .
Reporting
Storage
. . .
Commit
MPPS . . .
Section 3-15
Paperwork
NOTE: During and after installation, the documentation (i.e. User Manual, Installation Manual,...) for the
peripheral units must be kept as part of the original system documentation. This will ensure that all
relevant safety and user information is available during the operation and service of the complete
system.
Chapter 4
Functional Checks
Section 4-1
Overview
4-1-1 Purpose of Chapter 4
This chapter provides procedures for quickly checking major functions of the Voluson™S8 /
Voluson™S6 scanner diagnostics by using the built-in service software, and power supply adjustments.
4-5 Backup and Restore Database, Preset Configurations and Images 4-37
NOTICE Most of the information pertaining to this Functional Checks chapter is found in the Voluson™S8 /
!! NOTICE:
Voluson™S6 Basic User Manual; see: Table 9-10, “System Manuals - Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6,” on
page 9-18.
Section 4-2
Required Equipment
• An empty (blank) DVD/CD+R/RW and/or external USB device (stick or hard disk drive).
• At least one transducer. See Chapter 9 - Probes, on page 9-19 for an overview.
(normally you should check all the transducers used on the system)
Section 4-3
General Procedure
TAG
&
LOCKOUT
Signed Date
Circuit breaker
Pull-out protection
Figure 4-1 Circuit Breaker, pull-out protection and main power cable at rear of system
NOTICE When AC power is applied to the scanner, the ON/OFF button on the control panel illuminates amber,
!! NOTICE:
indicating that the System (including the Back-end Processor) is in Standby mode.
5.) Hold down the On/Off button (see: Figure 4-2) on the control panel for ~3 seconds.
NOTE: The power for on-board peripheral auxiliary equipments are commonly switched with the
ON/OFF button. The power switch of any attached printer(s) needs to be in ON position before starting
the system. However, be aware some auxiliary equipment may switch itself to standby mode
(e.g., Color video printer) and must therefore be switched on separately.
On/Off Button
As soon as the software has been loaded, the system enters 2D-Mode with the probe and application
that were used before the system was shut down. Total time used for start-up is about 2 minutes.
NOTE: The power for on-board peripheral auxiliary equipments are commonly switched with the
ON/OFF button. So the auxiliary equipment need not to be switched ON/OFF separately.
3.) Select the SHUTDOWN button. The system performs an automatic full shutdown sequence.
NOTE: Full shut down is also performed when pressing the ON/OFF button on the control panel twice.
4.) Switch OFF the Circuit Breaker at the rear of the system.
NOTE: The mains outlet of the system for peripheral auxiliary equipment are commonly switched with the
ON/OFF button. So the auxiliary equipment need not to be switched ON/OFF separately.
WARNING
WARNING Disconnection of the Main Power Cable is necessary!
!! WARNING:
For Example: When repairing the system.
5.) After complete power down, unscrew the 2 screws and remove the pull-out protection to disconnect
the main power cable from the system or unplug it from the AC wall outlet socket.
Circuit breaker
Pull-out protection
Figure 4-4 Circuit Breaker, pull-out protection and main power cable at rear of system
4-4 Section 4-3 - General Procedure
GE DRAFT VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 DRAFT (DECEMBER 12, 2017) BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
CAUTION DO NOT disconnect a probe while running (Live Scan “Write” mode)!
!! CAUTION:
A software error may occur. In this case switch the unit OFF (perform a reset).
7 Trackball
8 Alphanumeric Keyboard
Section 4-4
Functional Checks
For a basic functional check of the system’s different modes, following pages will familiarize you with
image optimization for:
NOTE: Some software may be considered standard depending upon system configuration.
If any Modes or Options are not part of the system configuration, the check can be omitted.
1 Rotate the 2D MODE key to adjust the sensitivity (brightness) of the entire
2D Mode Gain
image.
Transmit Power:
Transmit Power &
Optimizes image quality and allows user to reduce beam intensity.
Acoustic Output:
Acoustic Output of speakers
Adjustment of the Audio level of the speakers.
Focus Depth
3 To select the depth position of the actual focus zone(s). Arrows at the left
edge of the 2D-Image mark the active focal zone(s) by their depth position.
Depth
Adjusts the penetration depth range of the ultrasound image for the region
4 of interest.
The number of image lines and the frame rate are automatically optimized.
Multi Format (Dual, Quad) Press this keys to change the display Mode from Single to DUAL or QUAD
display mode.
5
Press the SINGLE format key or the 2D MODE key to change from Dual or
Quad to Single display.
2D Automatic Optimization Pressing the AUTO key causes automatic optimization of the gray scale to
6 enhance the contrast resolution.
Pressing again: optimization will be updated and remain active.
Press the AUTO key twice to switch off the Automatic Optimization in 2D.
Harmonic Imaging
Press the HI key on the control panel to switch on/off the Coded Harmonic
7
Imaging function in 2D Mode provided the active probe allows this function.
TGCSlider Control The °×TGC slide controls°± vary the gain in certain depths of the 2D image
to allow an exact compensation for the attenuation of the echoes over time
(depth).
Pulses are transmitted not only perpendicularly to the acoustic window, but
XBEAM CRI (CrossBeam
10 also in oblique directions. The advantages of XBeam CRI are enhanced
Compound Resolution Imaging)
contrast resolution with better tissue differentiation and clear organ borders.
Coded Excitation improves image resolution and penetration in the far field.
11 CE (Coded Excitation)
This allows to use a higher frequency on technically difficult patients.
Receiver Frequency Range The “Frequency range” function allows for the fast adjustment of high
resolution/lower penetration, mid resolution/mid penetration, or lower
resolution/ high penetration for the 2D image. From the transducer’s
13 broadband signal a certain start frequency and start bandwidth is extracted
and then continuously changed over depth. Every transducer has a set of
three fixed receive settings which are easily controlled by switching the
[Frequency] key.
Use the LEFT/RIGHT respectively the UP/DOWN keys on the Touch Panel
15 Image Orientation
to alternate the image orientation.
Use this control to select a part of interest of the 2D image. The advantage
16 ANGLE of the decreased field-of-view is an increased 2D frame rate due to the
smaller sector width.
18 OTI (Otimized Tissue Imaging) OTI™ allows to “fine tune” the system for scanning different kinds of tissue.
19
When entering freeze mode, by pressing the [Freeze] key or the defined [Px]
key, the cine memory will be stored as a sequence. This sequence can be
reviewed in loop mode or image by image. After the cine clip is stored the
cine memory will be deleted.
PERSIST.
Persistence is a temporal filter that averages frames together.
20 This has the effect of presenting a smoother, softer image.
This function is only available if XBEAM CRI is switched off.
LINE FILTER
The signals of the neighboring pulses are less weighted for the display of the
actual pulse which considerably improves the detail lateral resolution and
21
signal-to-noise ratio.
This function is only available if XBEAM CRI is switched off.
CRI FILTER
If this filter is set to “high”, the XBeam CRI-image is smoothed.
22 CRI Filter setting “off” leads to a sharper impression of the XBeam CRI-
image. This function is only available if XBEAM CRI is switched on.
DYNAMIC CONTROL
“Dynamic Control” allows you to enhance a part of interest of the grayscale
to make it easier to display pathology. You can select between twelve
different Dynamic control curves.
23
The dynamic control is displayed in the Image Info area on the screen.
Dynamic Control: 1 to 12
ENHANCE Edge Enhance brings out subtle tissue differences and boundaries by
25 enhancing the gray scale differences corresponding to the edges of
structures.
26 Selects a level below which echoes will not be amplified (an echo must have
REJECT
a certain minimum amplitude before it will be processed).
GRAY MAP
A gray map determines the displayed Brightness of an echo in relationship
27
to its amplitude.
TINT MAP
A Tint map determines the Chroma value (color tone and saturation) of an
28
echo in relationship to its amplitude.
For further details refer to the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Basic User Manual, Chapter 6, 2D Mode.
4-4-2-1 B-Flow
For further details refer to the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Basic User Manual, Chapter 6.6
For further details refer to the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Basic User Manual, Chapter 6.7.
Press the CONTRAST key to activate/deactivate the Coded Contrast Imaging mode.
For further details refer to the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Basic User Manual, Chapter 6.8.
2 Activation of M Mode Press the right or left trackball key to activate both Modes (2D/M).
3 M Mode Gain Rotate the M MODE key to adjust the sensitivity (brightness) of the entire M image.
5 INVERT Invert of the M Mode image. (Function is only available with endovaginal probes.)
11 REJECT It determines the amplitude-level below which echoes are suppressed (rejected).
13 DYNAMIC CONTROL. Dynamic Range enhances a part of the grayscale to make it easier to display pathology.
16 UTILITIES After pressing [Utilities], the menu area changes to the “Utilities” menu.
For further details refer to the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Basic User Manual, Chapter 7, M Mode.
By pressing the M control and the C control, the MCFM mode is switched on in the preparation mode.
The M-cursor with M-Color window appears on the active 2D image.
For further details refer to the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Basic User Manual, Chapter 7.4.
NOTE: The Continuous Wave Doppler Mode is an Option. The CW key is only illuminated if the option is
installed and the selected probe is capable for the Continuous Wave Doppler Mode.
8 The envelope curve of the Doppler spectrum (maximum velocities) and the
RT TRACE (Real Time Auto-Trace)
corresponding evaluations are automatically displayed on the monitor.
The angle cursor can be turned in both directions without stop. By pressing the
11 ANGLE
angle knob repeatedly the angle correction switches from +60° to 0° and to -60°.
12 BASELINE Adjusting the baseline is possible in read- and write Mode (up/down in 8 steps).
13 WMF (Wall Motion Filter) Used to eliminate Doppler “noise” that is caused by vessel wall motion.
The Velocity Range display is governed by the pulse repetition frequency (PRF)
14 PRF
Exceeding the maximum PRF, the HPRF-Mode is automatically switched on.
15 DYN. CONTR. Dynamic Range adjusts the display cutoff of the Doppler analysis waveform.
16 CENTER FREQUENCY It serves for selection of the required transmit frequency.
17 SCALE UNIT To select the displayed measuring unit (in relation to the zero-line).
18 DISPLAY FORMAT For selection of different rations of display format.
For further details refer to the Basic User Manual, Chapter 8, Doppler Mode.
NOTE: After pressing the PD key on the control panel, the HD-FLOW menu (to activate the Bi-Directional Angio
Mode) can be seen.
Table 4-6 Color Doppler Mode (CFM, PD, HD-Flow, TD) Functions
1 Color Box Position and Adjust the Box- Position resp. Size with the TRACKBALL in the 2DSingle image.
Color Box Size The upper trackball key changes from Box position to Box size.
CFM Gain Rotate the C MODE key to ensure that continuous flow is displayed, where appropriate.
PD Gain Rotate the PD MODE key to adjust the Power Doppler Gain
2
HD-Flow Gain Rotate the PD MODE key to adjust the Bi-Directional Angio Gain
TD Gain Rotate the C MODE key to adjust the Tissue Doppler Gain.
3 STEERING Beam Steering is only possible with linear probes in CFM, PD and HD-Flow Mode.
2D+2D/C (PD, HD-Flow Changes the Single image display to two simultaneous half images. The left frame shows only
4
or TD) the 2D Mode image. The right frame shows the 2D Mode image with color information.
5 INVERT The color of the color wedge inverts around the baseline. (impossible in PD Mode)
7 QUALITY Improves the Color Resolution by reducing the image frame rate, respectively vice versa.
Table 4-6 Color Doppler Mode (CFM, PD, HD-Flow, TD) Functions
Used to eliminate Doppler “noise” that is caused by vessel wall or cardiac wall motion.
8 WMF (Wall Motion Filter)
(CFM,PD, HD-Flow)
9 PRF By adjusting toward up the PRF increases. By adjusting toward the PRF decreases.
After FREEZE you can adjust the Color Threshold. It eliminates small color noise or motion
10 THRESHOLD
artifact signals in the color image. (small number cuts off less signals than a higher setting)
11 DISPL. MODE To select the CFM- Display Mode (V; V-T; V-Pow; Pow-T; or T).
To select different filter periods for rising velocity and falling velocity.
12 SMOOTH RISE Filtering of the rise velocity leads to noise suppression.
FALL This filter leads for “prolongation” of the display flow.
13 It serves for selection of the Transmit Frequency which also depends on the Color Box
FREQU.
position.
Controls the number of pulses to constitute one Color-, Power-Doppler or HD-Flow line in the
14 ENSEMBLE
display.
SCALE
17 The maximum velocities are displayed above and under the color scale in kHz, cm/s or m/s.
(CFM, HD-Flow, TD)
Provides selectability of the color coding for an optimization of the display of blood flow (similar
CFM-MAP
18 to the post-processing curves with grayscale 2D scans).
(PD, HD-Flow, TD)
After a selection has been made, the color bar displays the resultant map.
Gently means the transition between color and gray scale information.
The embedding of the color into 2D Mode is performed smoothly with less colored splashes.
19 GENTLY COLOR
To activate the “Gently Color” function, select the CFM MAP (PD, HD-Flow, TD) key in the
menu.
The Balance controls the amount of Color display over bright echoes and helps to confine
20 BALANCE
color within the vessel walls.
The baseline shift can be used to prevent aliasing in one flow direction similar to the Doppler
22 BASELINE
baseline shift. (Impossible in PD Mode.)
23 With “Line Filter” the signals of the neighboring pulses are less weighted for the display of the
LINE F.
actual pulse which considerably improves the detail lateral resolution and signal-to-noise ratio.
For further details refer to the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6, Basic User Manual:
NOTICE 4D Real Time 4D, STIC, VCI, VCI Omni View / SingleView, TUI, VOCAL II, SonoVCAD Heart,
!! NOTICE:
SonoVCAD labor and SonoAVC are Options. If options are not part of the system configuration, checks
can be omitted.
NOTE: Different menus are displayed depending on which Menu and which Volume Mode is selected(4D Real
Time or 3D Static) is selected.
NOTE: Some function keys only appear on the meun area if they are available for the selected Probe.
NOTE: SingleView is an option for Voluson S6 only. This will be activated when SingleView option is installed
and Advanced VCI (VCI-OmniView) option is not installed. SingleView supports only basic controls of
VCI-OmniView with Line method.
or
The Volume Mode function is switched on, the “3D Pre” respectively “4D Pre” menu appears
on the screen (write mode) and the volume box
5. Start the Volume Acquisition with the Freeze key resp. the right trackball key.
• 3D STATIC 3D Volume Mode - Static volume acquisition (also in combination with PD, HD-Flow or CFM)
• 4D REAL TIME Real Time 4D - continuous volume acquisition and parallel calculation of 3D rendered images
Volume Contrast Imaging - improves the contrast resolution and the signal / noise ratio and
• VCI A
therefore facilitates finding of diffuse lesions in organs
Volume Contrast Imaging Omni View (any plane) - improves the contrast resolution and the signal
• VCI OMNI VIEW /
/ noise ratio and therefore facilitates finding of diffuse lesions in organs.
SINGLEVIEW
Volumes can be edited in all other Visualization Modes.
• STIC The fetal heart or an artery can be visualized in 4D (also in combination with PD, HD-Flow or CFM)
• 4D BIOPSY Real Time 4D Biopsy - continuous volume acquisition + parallel calculation of 3D rendered images
1 QUALITY Changes the line density against the acquisition speed (low, mid1, mid2, high1, high2).
Volume Box Position Adjust the Volume Box (ROI) Position resp. Size with the TRACKBALL in the 2D Single image.
6
and Volume Box Size The upper trackball key to change the Trackball function from Box Position to Box Size.
7 Start Acquisition Press the FREEZE key resp. the right trackball key to start the Volume acquisition.
After the 3D acquisition the system switches automatically to the read menu. The selected format
• RENDER
will be present on the monitor (e.g., 3D ROI Mode: sectional planes A, B, C + rendered 3D image).
• SECTIONAL After the 3D Sectional Planes acquisition the system switches automatically to the read menu.
PLANES The selected format will be present on the monitor (e.g., A,B,C - Sectional Plane mode).
This method of visualization is consistent with the way other medical systems such as CT or MRI,
• TUI
present the data to the user (slices through the data set, which are parallel to each other).
The basic idea behind “VOCAL” is the combination of 3D ultrasound tissue (presented as voxels)
• VOLUME
and the geometric information of surfaces in a 3D data set. After definition of contour in 3D space
ANALYSIS
(semi-automatically, manually or spherical) a wide range of functionality is given.
• SONOVCAD Technology that automatically generates a number of views of the fetal heart.
HEART At this time it can help to find the right and left outflow tract of the heart and the fetal stomach.
• SONOVCAD Allows to measure fetal progression during the second stage of labor – fetal head progression,
LABOR rotation and direction. Visual evidence and objective data of the labor process are provided.
• SONOAVC This Feature can automatically detect low echogenic objects (e.g., follicles) in a volume of an
GENERAL organ (e.g., ovary) and analyze their shape and volume.
Parts of the orthogonal sections A, B and C are compiled to a 3D-section aspect. The name
• NICHE
“Niche” has been chosen because the aspect shows a quasi spatial cut into the reference image.
5 INIT Resets rotations and translations of a volume section to the initial (start) position.
Speckle Reduction Imaging (SRI) to reduce speckle which interferes with the
7 SRI / SRI 3D
sectional planes or rendered 3D image.
8 ZOOM The 3D image as well as the sectional planes can be varied by their aspect ratio.
10 TH. LOW All color values below the level will be disregarded for calculation of the surface.
11 MAGI CUT Ability to electronically manipulate the images and cut way “3D artifacts”.
12 RENDER MODE To select the Render Mode (Image Type and Render Algorithm)
2 GRAY/TINT MAPS Depending on individual requirements a “harder” or “softer” image can be obtained.
4 3D/4D INFO On/Off switch to show full or reduced Image Info parameter on screen.
On/Off switch to show an acquired 3D+CFM, 3D+PD or 3D+HD-Flow image with or without
5 3D COLOR OFF
the color information.
This function eliminates low color noise of motion artefact signals in the sectional slices as
9 POWER TRESH. well as in the rendered 3D image.
Note: Only available if a 3D+CFM, a 3D+PD or a 3D+HD-Flow image is acquired.
For further details refer to the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Basic User Manual, Chapter 9.
Move the TRACKBALL to display the images of the stored sequence. Use the FORMAT keys to
change to the next (part of) frozen 2D image sequence to play back the cine memory.
NOTE: The Cine-Split function (multiple format) is also possible in 2D Cine mode.
The UPPER TRACKBALL KEY changes from the 2D Cine to the D Loop (respectively M Loop).
NOTE: The active Cine is displayed on the monitor screen: 2D/D(M)-image or 2D/D(M)-image.
NOTE: After stopping a sequence, move the TRACKBALL to display the images / volumes one by one.
For further details refer to the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Basic User Manual, Chapter 13.
NOTE: The following instructions assume that you first scan the patient and then press FREEZE.
To toggle between active calipers, or to re-adjust the traced line, press the upper trackball key.
To erase results, press the CLEAR ALL key on the control panel or the DELETE STUDY. on the
keyboard.
NOTE: To alternate the control from one cursor to the other, press CHANGE (the upper trackball key).
To re-adjust a traced line, press UNDO (the upper trackball key) repeatedly.
NOTE: To exit Generic measurements, select the EXIT key on the Touch Panel, press the CALIPER key or the
EXIT key on the control panel.
NOTE: If you have selected a “trace” item, the measurement is finished and the area and circumference results
appear on the screen.
6.) An ellipse appears the axis of which is defined by these two points.
To adjust the width of the ellipse, move the TRACKBALL.
7.) To toggle between calipers, or to readjust a traced line, press the upper trackball key.
8.) To complete the measurement, press SET (right or left trackball key). The system displays the
circumference and area in the measurement results area.
Before you complete a measurement:
- To erase the ellipse resp. trace and the current data measured, select CANCEL once and
select DELETE LAST on the menu area.
The original caliper is displayed to restart the measurement.
- To exit the measurement function without completing the measurement, select EXIT on the
menu area, press the CALIPER key again or press EXIT on the control panel.
1.) Select the reference image in which the measurement is to be performed (A, B or C).
2.) Press the CALIPER key once and then select MULTIPLANE on the menu area.
3.) Select the first section through the body by rotating the REF.SLICE or by rotating the C MODE
digipot. (first section should be set at the edge of the object)
4.) Position the start dot of the area which should be surrounded and store it with SET.
5.) Surround the area with the trackball, then press SET (right or left trackball key). The area is
calculated and displayed. It may even be “zero”. Press the SET key twice.
6.) Select the next parallel section with the REF. SLICE digipot or the C MODE digipot, and
measure the area.
7.) Repeat 5. and 6. until the edge of the measured object is reached.
NOTE: To erase the results, select the CLEAR key on the control panel.
NOTE: The Spectral Doppler image is displayed based on time (X-axis) and velocity (Y-axis).
- To readjust the start cycle (vertical yellow line), press CHANGE (upper trackball key).
Press SET (right or left trackball key) to fix the line.
- Press the CHANGE key again to readjust the end cycle (vertical green line).
Press SET to fix the line.
NOTE: The determination of the envelope curve requires a clear and low-noise record of the Doppler
spectrum. Otherwise the reliability of the displayed measurement results may not be ensured!
To readjust the traced line, press UNDO (upper trackball key) repeatedly.
NOTE: For further Doppler Measurements and other details refer to the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Basic
User Manual, Chapter 11
4-4-9 Calculations
The Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 system supports calculation packages and application-oriented
patient Worksheets (Reports) for following applications:
• Abdomen Calculations
• Small Parts Calculations
• Obstetric Calculations
• Cardiology Calculations
• Urology Calculations
• Vascular Calculations
• Gynecology Calculations
• Pediatric Calculations
• Neurology Calculations
• Musculoskeletal Calculations
NOTE: Confirm that the patient information is correct and the probe and application are selected properly.
For further details refer to the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Basic User Manual, Chapter 11
General remarks to perform Calculations:
• By pressing the CALC key on the control panel the Calculation function is switched on.
• Positioning of measurement marks is done with the TRACKBALL.
• Entering and storage of measuring marks is done with SET (right or left trackball key).
• To change measuring marks before completion press CHANGE (upper trackball key).
• Depending on the setting in the Measure Setup, also the FREEZE key can be used for confirming
the last measuring mark of the currently performed measurement.
• The status bar area shows the current function of the trackball.
• To cancel the measurement of the currently selected item, select CANCEL on the menu area.
• To delete the results of the last measured item, select DELETE LAST on the menu area.
• To delete all measurement results of the selected “Study” from the monitor as well as from the
corresponding Worksheet, select the CLEAR STUDY key on the menu area.
• All measurement results will be automatically included in the corresponding patient worksheet.
• To erase measurement results from the screen, press the CLEAR key on the control panel or press
the DEL key on the keyboard.
• To exit from Calculations select the EXIT key on the menu area, press the CALC key or press the
EXIT key on the control panel.
Press the REPORT key on the control panel to view the “application dependent” patient worksheet
pages that contain the results of calculations and measurements. Any stored patient worksheet can be
edited, printed, transferred, saved in the Archive or sent to DICOM server.
CAUTION If a probe is disconnected while running (write mode) a software error may occur.
!! CAUTION:
In this case switch the unit OFF (perform a reset).
1.) Remove the cable from the cable holder and close the door.
2.) Move lever to the right position to lock probe. Pull the probe and connector straight out of the
probe port.
3.) Carefully slide the probe and connector away from the probe port and around the right side of
the keyboard. Ensure the cable is free.
• Current Patient:
The entered patient data will be used in calculations, patient worksheets, DICOM settings and is
displayed on the screen to identify images.
• Archive:
The patient archive database is used for searching a particular exam and/or patient.
Via the ARCHIVE button, it is possible to send images over the DICOM network, print exams/
images, export exams/images, import exams/images, etc.
• Image History:
Image History gives you access to all the US pictures and exams of a particular patient.
• Exam Review:
Exam Review allows you to view all exams of a particular patient. Additionally it is possible to view
image properties, input comments and voice annotations, etc.
NOTE: For detailed description of image management functionality and its topics refer to Chapter 12 in the
Basic User Manual of Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6.
NOTE: Images can be backed up and restored by means of the Image Archive function in the System Setup.
Operation see: Section 4-5-7 "Archiving Images" on page 4-48.
4.) Click the ERASE CD button to displays the “Erase DVD/CD” window as shown in Figure 4-19.
5.) Select the “Erase Mode” and click the [OK] button to start the process.
NOTICE It is highly recommended to use the complete erase mode, to avoid problems with the CD+(R)W!
!! NOTICE:
When using a DVD+R/RW, just the fast erase mode is possible.
6.) When erasing is finished, select EXIT to return to the Scan Mode.
Section 4-5
Backup and Restore Database, Preset Configurations and Images
CAUTION It is recommended to Backup the Full System Configuration (Section 4-5-4 on page 4-43) and the
!! CAUTION:
Image Archive (Section 4-5-7 on page 4-48) once a week.
The Image Settings and/or Full System Configuration can be saved to the following destinations:
• Application Settings
• User Programs
• Auto Text
• 3D/4D Programs
• Scan Assistant
1.) Insert a DVD/CD+R/RW into the drive or connect an external USB device.
2.) Press the UTILITIES key on the control panel.
3.) In the “Utilities” menu select SYSTEM SETUP to invoke the setup desktop on the screen.
4.) On the left side of the screen select BACKUP and then click the SYSTEM CONFIGURATION tab.
5.) Click the SAVE button of the “Small Backup(Scan Settings)” group.
Choose media
and
4-38 Section 4-5 - Backup and Restore Database, Preset Configurations and Images
GE DRAFT VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 DRAFT (DECEMBER 12, 2017) BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
4-5-2-1 Preparations
1.) Insert a DVD/CD+R/RW into the drive or connect an external USB device.
2.) Press the UTILITIES key on the control panel.
3.) Select SYSTEM SETUP button to invoke the setup desktop.
4.) On the left side of the screen select BACKUP and then click the SYSTEM CONFIGURATION tab.
5.) Click the LOAD button of the “Small Backup (Scan Settings)” group.
Choose media
and
NOTE: If it is desired to load image settings from media Internal HDD, click on the CHANGE FOLDER button,
browse for the folder “D:\usersettings” and then click the LOAD button.
NOTE: Following procedure should be used, if the user prefers factory default settings, which are adapted for
the installed Application Software version.
>> button
Complete Backup
[Load] button
3.) Click the LOAD button to start the loading procedure of the complete backup into the system.
The US Application Software restarts.
4-40 Section 4-5 - Backup and Restore Database, Preset Configurations and Images
GE DRAFT VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 DRAFT (DECEMBER 12, 2017) BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
NOTE: Following procedure should be used, if the user has saved own User Programs, 3D/4D Programs or
AutoText entries, but new presets have to be added to match the installed Application Software version
(e.g., User Programs and 3D/4D Programs for new probe, etc.).
copy desired
[+] sign content into
right field
>> button
[Load] button
3.) Click the + sign next to “UserPrograms”, select the desired probe(s) and copy the content by clicking
the >> button.
4.) Click the + sign next to “3D/4D Programs”, select the desired probe(s) and copy the content by
clicking the >> button.
NOTE: To return selected items from the “Load Data” field to “Backup Data” field select the << button.
4-42 Section 4-5 - Backup and Restore Database, Preset Configurations and Images
GE DRAFT VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 DRAFT (DECEMBER 12, 2017) BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
A backup of the Full System Configuration always contains the following data
• User Settings (databases and files containing User Programs, 2D/3D/4D Programs, Auto Text
entries, gray curves and complete System settings such as language, time/date format, etc.)
• Measure Configuration (user specific measure setup settings)
• Patient Archive (database containing patient demographic data and measurements) - no images
• Options (Permanent Key that is specific for enabled software options and Demo Key)
• Image Transfer Configuration (DICOM settings e.g., DICOM servers, AE Title, Station Name, etc.)
• Network Configuration (network settings including the computer name)
• Service Platform (state of the Service Software)
NOTE: It is recommended to “Full Backup” system configuration data before upgrading the software and/or
image settings (presets). This ensures that if settings need to be reloaded, will be the same ones the
customer was using prior to service.
choose destination
enter description
When the “Full Backup” is saved on a network drive (to map a network drive see: Section 3-13-1 "Map
Network Drive" on page 3-81), it may be desirable to move the data (e.g., for backup or maintenance).
The backups reside in sub folders of the main “fullbackup” -folder found at the root of the drive.
For Example: Backups on the mapped Network Drive are below path Z:\fullbackup.
NOTICE When the backup is saved to an external USB-device, the system has to be informed about the removal
!! NOTICE:
of the hardware. For this purpose every last dialog of "Full Backup Save" and "Full Backup Delete" has
a STOP USB DEVICES button (see: Figure 4-29).
4-44 Section 4-5 - Backup and Restore Database, Preset Configurations and Images
GE DRAFT VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 DRAFT (DECEMBER 12, 2017) BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
WARNING
WARNING It is recommended to backup data before an upgrade; see: Section 4-5-4 on page 4-43.
!! WARNING:
The “Full Backup” loading procedure replaces (overwrites) ALL the existing data
(except Application Settings which are adapted for the used System software version)
on the local hard drive of the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 system!
NOTICE It is neither required nor advisable to reload a previously stored “Full Backup” after a software
!! NOTICE:
upgrade that was performed by means of the FMI FROM DVD button!
CAUTION There are circumstances where it is not possible to load (restore) all the data.
!! CAUTION:
The following rules specify these restrictions:
1.) Generally, only restoring data from an older to a newer software version is possible.
Loading a backup into a system that has a lower software version than the system the backup was
created on is prohibited.
2.) Options can only be restored on the same Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 system within the same
major software version.
3.) When loading a backup into a system with a software version that has a higher major number, the
following items will not be restored:
A.) Options
B.) State of the Service Platform
4.) The user is only allowed to restore data to a different system if and only if the software version on
this system is the same as in the backup.
5.) The user is not allowed to restore the following items to a different system:
A.) Windows Network Settings
B.) Options
C.) DICOM AE Title
D.) DICOM Station Name
E.) State of the Service Platform
Choose Destination
Select Backup
Click [Next]
click [Next]
4-46 Section 4-5 - Backup and Restore Database, Preset Configurations and Images
GE DRAFT VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 DRAFT (DECEMBER 12, 2017) BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
WARNING
WARNING
!! WARNING:
After restoring the data, the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 reboots and the application starts again.
Choose Destination
Select Backup
Click [Delete]
WARNING
WARNING There is no “ UNDO” function for this action!
!! WARNING:
NOTE: A backup of the Image Archive always contains the Patient Archive (database containing patient
demographic data and measurements) + images of the selected exams.
[Load] button
[Save] button
[Advanced] button
choose archiving
span time
4-48 Section 4-5 - Backup and Restore Database, Preset Configurations and Images
GE DRAFT VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 DRAFT (DECEMBER 12, 2017) BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
NOTICE If for example “All images older than” 1 Day is chosen (see Figure 4-35 on page 4-48), images of the
!! NOTICE:
current day will not be archived! However, if you click the [Advanced] button you can put this right.
choose destination
enter backup
description
CAUTION Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 presets, configurations and image settings will not be backed up!
!! CAUTION:
To Backup the Full System Configuration refer to Section 4-5-4 on page 4-43.
choose destination
8.) Select (check mark) the image archive data to be restored to the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6
system.
9.) Click the NEXT button and then select YES to start, or NO to cancel the restore procedure.
4-50 Section 4-5 - Backup and Restore Database, Preset Configurations and Images
GE DRAFT VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 DRAFT (DECEMBER 12, 2017) BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
Section 4-6
Software Configuration Checks
4-6-1 System Setup
Press the UTILITIES key on the control panel and then select SYSTEM SETUP.
On the left side of the screen select the desired major group.
Each major group contains different pages to check:
2 General: Check that Location (Clinic Name) is correct Location Name is correct
5 User Setting: Check all the User Settings settings assigned as desired by the customer
6 Patient Info Display: Check all settings settings assigned as desired by the customer
2 Peripherals: Check assignment of Foot Switch Footswitch left/right are assigned as desired by the customer
3 Device Setup:
setting assigned as desired and required by the customer
Check DICOM, Network and Archive configuration
Button Configuration:
4 Remote keys are assigned as desired by the customer
Check assignment of remote keys P1, P2, P3 and P4.
Button Configuration:
5 buttons are assigned as desired by the customer
Check assignment of START EXAM and END EXAM
Application Parameters:
2 setting assigned as desired by the customer
Check all settings for all applications
3 Global Parameters: Check all settings setting assigned as desired by the customer
Section 4-7
Peripheral Checks
Check that peripherals work as described below:
Press the remote key (P1, P2, P3 or P4 ), The image displayed on the screen is printed on the Black & White
2
which is assigned to the BW printer. printer.
Section 4-8
Site Log
Table 4-16 Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 - Site Log (Paper Documentation)
Chapter 5
Components and Functions (Theory)
Section 5-1
Overview
5-1-1 Purpose of Chapter 5
This chapter explains Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6’s system concepts, component arrangement, and
subsystem function. It also describes the Power Distribution scheme and probes.
Section 5-2
General Information
Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 is a digital beamforming curved-, linear- and phased array ultrasound
imaging system.
• 2D Mode Imaging and additional Operating Modes (B-Flow, XTD-View, Coded Contrast Imaging)
• Color Doppler Imaging (CFM, PD, TD and HD-Flow)
• M Mode + MCFM Imaging
• Doppler (PW, CW)
• 3D Mode and Real Time 4D Imaging
• Different combinations of the above modes
Probe Connectors
Footrest
and Probe storage connector
Brakes to block the (rightmost - not active for scanning)
front wheels
Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 has a digital beam forming system (incorporated in the FrontEnd) which
can handle up to 192 element probes by use of multiplexing.
Signal flow from the Probe Connector Panel, to the FrontEnd (FE) Electronics, to the BackEnd
Processor, and finally is displayed on the LCD monitor and peripherals.
• Abdomen (ABD)
• Obstetrics (OB)
• Gynecology (GYN)
• Cardiology (CARD)
• Urology (URO)
• Vascular (VAS)
• Neurology (NEURO)
• Small Parts (SM P)
• Pediatrics (PED)
• Musculoskeletal (MSK)
The Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 supports a variety of linear- and curved array for various clinical
applications.
Any 3 probes may be connected at the same time.
• Obstetrics
• Gynecology and Fertility
• Radiology
• Neurology
• Oncology
• Urology
• Pediatrics
• Musculoskeletal
The system is designed for follow-up expansion.
In addition to the initial operational settings for each transducer pre-programmed in the system, user-
customized parameter settings for each transducer may be inserted by the operator and stored for recall
as needed via the system control panel. System configuration is stored on the hard drive and all
necessary software is loaded from the hard drive on power up.
Biopsy guidelines are provided on screen to assist in the collection of tissue samples, using biopsy
guide adapters offered as an optional accessory.
The system provides the ability to perform remote viewing of images without compression, via DICOM
3.0 compatible output. Management of patient history is possible by image-filing function.
High-resolution images are provided by utilizing a technology called digital dynamic receive focusing.
For more detailed explanations of functions and controls refer to the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Basic
User Manual.
5-2-1-1-3 XTD-View
XTD-View (Extended View) provides the ability to construct and view a static 2D image which is
wider than the field of view of a given transducer. This feature allows viewing and measurement of
anatomy that is larger than what would fit in a single image. XTD-View constructs the extended
image from individual image frames as the operator slides the transducer along the surface of the
skin in direction of the scan plane.
Examples include scanning of vascular structures and connective tissues in the arms and legs.
5-2-1-2 M-Mode
In M-mode, soft tissue structure is presented as scrolling display, with depth on the Y-axis and time on
the X-axis. It is used primarily for cardiac measurements such as value timing on septal wall thickness
when accurate timing information is required. M-mode is also known as T-M mode or time-motion mode.
Ultrasound echoes of different intensities are mapped to different gray scale values in the display.
M-mode displays time motion information of the ultrasound data derived from a stationary beam.
Depth is arranged along the vertical axis with time along the horizontal axis. M-mode is normally used
in conjunction with a 2D image for spatial reference. The 2D image has a graphical line (M-line)
superimposed on the 2D image indicating where the M-mode beam is located.
• Color Flow Mode (C) - used to visualize blood flow velocity and direction
• Power Doppler (PD) - used to visualize the spatial distribution of blood
• Bi-Directional Angio (HD-Flow) - used to visualize flow direction with spatial resolution and low
artifact visibility
• Tissue Doppler (TD) - used to visualize tissue motion direction and velocity
5-2-1-5 3D Imaging
The Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Ultrasound System will be used to acquire multiple, sequential 2D
images which can be combined to reconstruct a three dimensional image. These 3D images are useful
in visualizing three-dimensional structures, and in understanding the spatial or temporal relationships
between the images in the 2D sequence. The 3D image is presented using standard visualization
techniques, such as surface or volume rendering.
2D ultrasound imaging modes are used to view a two dimensional cross-sections of parts of the body.
For example in 2D gray scale imaging, a 2 dimensional cross-section of a 3-dimensional soft-tissue
structure such as the heart is displayed in real time. Typically, the user of an ultrasound machine
manipulates the position and orientation of this 2D cross-section in real time during an ultrasound exam.
By changing the position of the cross-section, a variety of views of the underlying structure are obtained,
and these views can be used to understand a 3-dimensional structure in the body.
To complete survey a 3-dimensional structure in the body, it is necessary to collect 2D images which
span a volume containing the structure. One way is to sweep the imaging cross-section by translating
it in a direction perpendicular to the cross-section. Another example method is to rotate the cross
section about a line contained in the cross section. The Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Ultrasound System
uses the automated so called C-Scan for the motion perpendicular to automated B-scan. Once a
representative set of 2D cross-sections are obtained, standard reconstruction techniques can be used
to construct other 2D cross-sections, or to view the collection of the cross-sections as a 3D images.
5-2-1-8 3D Rendering
The 3D (volume) rendering is a calculation process to visualize certain 3D-structures of a scanned
volume by means of a 2D-image. The gray value for each pixel of the 2D-image is calculated from the
voxels along the corresponding projection path (analyzing beam) through the volume. The render
(calculation) algorithm, surface or transparent mode, determines how 3D-structures are visualized.
VOXEL
X
X PROJECTION WAY
PIXEL
Z
Y
VOLU
ME -
BLOC
K
Y
ISPLA
2D - D
Figure 5-3 Principle: Volume Rendering
5-2-3-1 B-Mode
1.) RFS
The RFS contains the Clock-Management and PRF-Generator.
It generates(drives) BF(=Beamformer)-FPGA-Clock (200MHz) and Shot-Trigger for the
Beamformer board (BF128II or BF64II).
Configures PIR (Probe Interface board) and Beamformer (BF128II or BF64II with Tx-Frequency,
Tx-Focus, Rx-Focus, LineNo (lateral Position), Tx- Apodization, RX-Apodization, Multibeam, etc.
The RFS board also contains the Tx-Power-Reference-DAC.
Furthermore it contains Multibeam-DeInterleave, Subtraction Filter (for HI-Mode, see: Section 5-2-
3-1-1 "Special B-Mode Techniques" on page 5-12, DigitalTGC, DC-Canceler, Mixer (Part of
Demodulator), LowPassFilter, Decimation (Pixel rate Conversion), Magnitude Calculator (Part of
Demodulator), Logarithmic Amplifier, Re-Sample, Edge Enhance (Contrast Enhancement through
differentiation), Frame Filter, Blending (adapting Brightness in order to perfectly combine Nearfield-
Frame with Farfield-Frame in FFC-Mode, see: Section 5-2-3-1-1 "Special B-Mode Techniques" on
page 5-12.
After DC-cancelling the signal is mixed with RX-Frequency and brought to LF-Spectrum, where the
LowPassFilter cuts HF. Mixer and Magnitude-Calculator arrange Complex Demodulation, and
Logarithmic Amplifier arrange the conversion from High-Dynamic LinearSignal to the Low-
Dynamik(e.g.8Bit) Log-Signal. Several Postprocessing steps (LineFilter, FrameFilter, ReSample,
Edge Enhance) enable smooth image quality while keeping contrast high.
5-2-3-2 M-Mode
1.) RFS
see: Section 5-2-3-1 "B-Mode" on page 5-12
Advanced SRI
5-2-4-13 Advanced SRI X S
(SRI II)
Legend: X = Optional Feature (separately purchasable) S = Standard Feature N/A = Not available
5-2-4-2 HDLive(3D)
HD Live is an enhancement of the currently available Surface Rendering. The position of the virtual light
source may be altered to get a natural display with an optimized depth impression.
Static VCI is a part of the VCI option, which allow to apply the contrast enhancing VCI method to
3D data sets after the acquisition.
5-2-4-5 DICOM
Software package providing following DICOM functionality:
5-2-4-6 B-Flow
B-Flow is especially intuitive when viewing blood flow, for acute thrombosis, parenchymal flow and jets.
It helps to visualize complex hemodynamics and highlights moving blood in tissue.
B-Flow is less angle dependent, no velocity aliasing artifacts, displays a full field of view and provides
better resolution when compared with Color-Doppler Mode. It is therefore a more realistic (intuitive)
representation of flow information, allowing to view both high and low velocity flow at the same time.
5-2-4-7 Elastography
Elastography refers to the measurement of elastic properties of tissues, based on the well-established
principle that malignant tissue is harder than benign tissue.
Elastography shows the spatial distribution of tissue elasticity properties in a region of interest by
estimating the strain before and after tissue distortion caused by external or internal forces. The strain
estimation is filtered and scaled to provide a smooth presentation when displayed.
During scanning in the elastography mode, the examiner manually slightly compresses the tissue using
the ultrasound probe. A strain correlation (strain is the deformation of the tissue by compression) is
continuously performed for visual perception on the monitor.
All SonoVCAD labor measurements (Head direction, Midline Angle, Progression Distance, Progression
Angle and associated acquisition time) are automatically added to the worksheet, as soon as they are
performed. Only one measurement result is available for each measurement type. If the measurement
is repeated, the old result is replaced by the new result.
If a volume is deleted, the according measurements are not deleted from the worksheet.
The method applied in the subject modification utilizes a nonlinear diffusion filtering technique that
permits effective speckle reduction in real time. The speckle reduction filter is available to the user in all
B-mode imaging, independent of the transducer used.
5-2-4-14 SonoNT
SonoNT is an additional function for manual NT (Nuchal Translucency) measurement. This function
supports the user to find the correct position for the NT measurement. The user can switch between NT
Method “Manual” and “Sono NT” (semi-automatic).
A Box has to be placed for the NT-ROI. Then the NT-distance is calculated automatically, a graphic
(yellow head-image) and the NT-result are displayed.
5-2-4-15 STIC
With this acquisition method the fetal heart or an artery can be visualized in 4D. It is not a Real Time 4D
technique, but a post processed 3D acquisition.
In order to archive a good result, try to adjust the size of the volume box and the sweep angle to be as
small as possible. The longer the acquisition time, the better the spatial resolution will be. A good STIC,
STIC CFM (2D+CFM), STIC PD (2D+PD) or STIC HD (2D+HD-Flow) data set shows a regular and
synchronous pumping of the fetal heart or of an artery.
The user must be sure that there is minimal movement of the participating persons (e.g., mother and
fetus), and that the probe is held absolutely still throughout the acquisition period. Movement will cause
a failure of the acquisition. The acquired images are post processed to calculate a 4D Volume Cine
sequence. Please make sure that the borders of the fetal heart or the artery are smooth and there are
no sudden discontinuities. If the user (trained operator) clearly recognizes a disturbance during the
acquisition period, the acquisition has to be cancelled.
• STIC - Fetal Cardio is only available on RAB & RIC probes in the OB/GYN application.
• STIC - Vascular is only available on the RSP probe in the Peripheral Vascular application.
5-2-4-16 ScanAssistant
All major ultrasound societies (SMFM, AIUM, ACR, ACOG) have guidelines to be followed for each
examination. For legal reasons, documentation is recommended for all structures evaluated.
Scan Assistant prevents the user from missing an important step of an examination. Completely
customizable, each exam can have sub menus that allow measurements and annotations to be tagged
for transfer with DICOM and DICOM SR.
5-2-4-17 TUI
TUI is a new visualization mode for 3D and 4D data sets. The data is presented as slices through the
data set which are parallel to each other. An overview image, which is orthogonal to the parallel slices,
shows which parts of the volume are displayed in the parallel planes.
This method of visualization is consistent with the way other medical systems such as CT or MRI,
present the data to the user. The distance between the different planes can be adjusted to the
requirements of the given data set. In addition it is possible to set the number of planes.
The planes and the overview image can also be printed to a DICOM printer, for easier comparison of
the ultrasound data with CT and/or MRI data.
The user is able to see the region of interest in three perpendicular planes (longitudinal, transversal and
frontal section) and can guide the biopsy needle accurately into the centre of the lesion.
5-2-4-19 Inversion
Inversion render mode is used to display anechoic structures such as vessels (fluid to solid). This gray
render mode inverts the gray values of the rendered image (e.g., image information that was black
becomes white and vice versa).
5-2-4-20 VOCAL II
VOCAL II - Imaging program opens up completely new possibilities in cancer diagnosis, therapy
planning and follow-up therapy control. It offers different functions:
• Manual or Semi automatic Contour detection of structures (such as tumor lesion, cyst,prostate, etc.)
and subsequent volume calculation.The accuracy of the process can be visually controlled by the
examiner in multi-planardisplay.
• Construction of a virtual shell around the contour of the lesion. The wall thickness of the shell can
be defined. The shell can be imagined as a layer of tissue around the lesion, where the tumor
vascularization takes place.
• Automatic calculation of the vascularization within the shell by 3D color histogram by comparing the
number of color voxels to the number of grayscale voxels.
5-2-4-21 SonoIT
SonoIT (Sonography based Intracranial Translucency) is a system supported measurement for
Intracranial Translucency. Starting from the routinely used midsagittal view of the fetal face, obtained
for assessment of the Nuchal Translucency and nasal bone, the ultrasound system uses a semi-
automated mode to measure the anterior-posterior diameter of the fourth ventricle recognizable as
intracranial translucency. The workflow is identical with SonoNT.
5-2-4-22 SonoBiometry
SonoBiometry is an alternative to the common fetal biometry measurements. It provides system
suggested measurements for BPD, HC, AC and FL which need to be confirmed by the user or can be
changed manually.
HW-Options Description
1 CW-Doppler 5-2-5-1 CW - Continuous Wave Doppler
4 WLAN Network Adapter 5-2-5-4 Wireless Network Adapter (WLAN - Wireless Local Area Network)
C: System partition:
- Operating System (Windows XP) including all Windows settings (IP-address, Network Name,
etc.)
- US-Application Software (UISAPP)
- Global Service Platform Software
- Software Options
D: User partition:
R: Rescue partition:
- Factory Images of C:Partition for System recovery after HDD (Windows) crash
- Printer Drivers
Section 5-3
FrontEnd Processor
Table 5-4 below outlines the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Front End components described in the sub-
sections.
Table 5-4 Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 - Front End components
• 3 RS-Probe Connectors
• 1 RS-Dummy Probe Connector
• Probe Select Relays
• Probe Recognition
Section 5-4
BackEnd Processor
For further details see: Section 5-2-6 "Data Location" on page 5-21.
5-4-2-1 Congatec
SOM Module for RFS-G Assy (HDLive):
Major Tasks:
- System Control
- 2D- / 3D- / 4D- Image processing and Rendering
Section 5-5
Internal I/O
Section 5-6
OPIO (User Interface)
5-6-1 OPIO Block Diagram
A/N Key
8 wire (USB (4) + LED backlight) USB Cable
USB HUB Down Stream(2)
* Stanby 3.3V
Stanby
26Pin Flat Cable
Power LED(4)
Function S/W (9)
HOST LED Backlight LED
* USB-2 Control
Communication (36)
* USB-1
Communication
Power Cable SUB
Assembly 6P Wire
* +12V Power
Backlight
USB LED &
* Stanby 3.3V HUB Micro Control Highlight LED
Controller Asynchrous Serial
(174)
Atmega
(USB)
Encoder (10)
26Pin Flat Cable CPLD
WHEEL(1)
8-Bit Serial Function S/W (40)
USB
Trackball
The Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 OPIO (User Interface) consists of the following electronic
subassemblies and/or functional components:
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
52 53 55 57
54 13
11 12
56 58
68 69 49 45 50 51 14 15 16 70 71
44 46
48
43 47
30 32
24
17 18 23 25 31 33
65 28 29
19 20
60
72 26 27 34 35 36 37
21
38 39 40 41
22 59 61
42
62 64
63
66
67
Section 5-7
Monitor
NOTE: From BT15 system, it's accessible via not monitor adjustment but monitor menu on application. Please
refer to Section 6-3-1.
Section 5-8
External I/O
NOTE: For further description of I/O connectors refer to Section 3-9-4 "External I/O Connectors" on page 3-71.
Section 5-9
Peripherals
5-9-1 Recording Tools
5-9-1-1 DVD Recorder
The DVR recorder is implemmented by installing the DVR Module on RFS incorporating with DVD
Drive.
5-9-2 Printers
5-9-2-1 Black & White Digital Printer
The B&W Digital Printer receives image data via the USB port. The print command is controlled by the
keys P1, P2, P3 or P4 on the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 control panel (depending on system
configuration).
The Wireless Network USB Adapter provides a mobile network connection to the local area network.
5-9-6 Footswitch
The Footswitch is used for comfortable system control when no hand is free.
To adjust function of the Footswitch (Left/Right) see: Section 3-9-1-6 on page 3-68.
Section 5-10
Power Distribution
5-10-1 ACFE - Primary Power Module
Circuit breaker
Equipotential connection
pull-out protection
The AC Power’s main tasks are to supply the internal subsystems with AC power. To reduce inrush
current, an inrush current limiter is implemented.
Voltage to peripherals are provided from input without configuration.
From the Mains Power Input module, the AC power is routed via an Inrush Current Limiter to an internal
ACDC module.
NOTE: All DC-supply voltages for built in peripherals are generated in DCDC module not inside ACFE.
NOTICE The systems mains supply input voltage is a free voltage not need to configure for different AC power-
!! NOTICE:
in.
5-10-4 4D Module
In addition, the AC/DC device contains the digital motor amplifier.
Section 5-11
Mechanical Descriptions
5-11-1 Physical Dimensions
27cm
+/- 30°
Press the ‘Rotate’ button in the outside of the front handlebar to rotate the OPIO to the desired position.
Release the ‘Rotate’ button in order to secure the console against movement.
OPIO height adjustment is done with the button in the outside of the front handlebar.
As long as this key is pressed, OPIO can be elevated UP or DOWN by manually
(Rear)
Main Air
Outlet
(Side)
Main Air
inlet(Filter grid)
Section 5-12
Service Platform
5-12-1 Introduction
The Service Platform will increase service productivity and reduce training and service costs.
select : GE Service
The Common Service Desktop (CSD) is started and the [Home] page - containing basic System
Information - appears. The navigation bar at the top of the screen allows to select different tools.
Chapter 5 - Components and Functions (Theory) 5-49
GE RAFT VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 DRAFT (DECEMBER 12, 2017) BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
For more detailed information and description refer to Section 5-13 on page 5-52.
NOTICE Remote access is ONLY possible if the service platform is properly configured (either by the user
!! NOTICE:
or a GE technician at site). Operation see: Section 7-5-7 "CSD: Configuration" on page 7-29.
This offers GE technicians the possibility to view the entire customer´s desktop and operation system.
Remote access to the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 scanner requires permission and customer input to
run diagnostics.
“Disruptive Mode” can be selected by the customer directly on the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6
ultrasound system (as described below), or remotely by the service technician or OLC.
Cancel (disable)
Connect Clinical Lifeline (enable)
GE icon
NOTE: Visual information about the network status is shown in the status area on the bottom of the screen.
Disruptive Mode and Virtual Console Observation (VCO) is enabled. Remote Access
Green = Active State
is active.
4.) If you select Cancel, “Disruptive Mode” and “VCO” is turned OFF.
Section 5-13
Common Service Desktop (CSD)
5-13-1 Internationalization
The user interface provided by the service platform is designed for GE personnel and as such is in
English only. There is no multi-lingual capability built into the Service Interface.
There are different possibilities to access the Common Service Desktop and its available features:
The navigation bar at the top of the screen allows to select from following tools:
5-13-3 Diagnostics
The Diagnostic page uses a web-controlled user interface to provide access to common service
components and perform diagnostics.
• Non-Interactive: The tests are performed without the user’s intervention.
• Interactive: The user is required to perform an operation on the ultrasound unit in order for the test
to be completed successfully. This option is not applicable when used remotely.
5-13-5 Configuration
In the Configuration page, you can view and modify different device informations and configurations.
in the “InsiteExC Agent Configuration” option field.
NOTICE Remote access is ONLY possible if the service platform is properly configured (either by the user
!! NOTICE:
or a GE technician at site). Operation see: Section 7-5-7 "CSD: Configuration" on page 7-29.
5-13-6 Utilities
The Utilities page contains a variety of Windows utility tools to indicate the status of the system,
in addition to various other tools.
5-13-7 Replacement
In the Replacement page, Hardware parts and their versions are displayed.
5-13-8 PM
In the PM page, information about planned, proactive and preventive maintenance is displayed, as
described in Chapter 10 - Care & Maintenance, on page 10-1.
Section 5-14
Service Page
5-14-1 Introduction
The Service Page contains specific software/hardware test modules, system setup, update, etc. for
Voluson systems only.
Monitor Test
Common
Auto Tester
Service Desktop
Request for
Update Service
Load Application
Settings
Keyboard Layout
TCP/IP Buffersize Exit
NOTICE For intermittent problems this file can be requested from the Service Engineer or customer.
!! NOTICE:
It is possible to burn this file on DVD/CD+R/RW.
Operation see: Section 7-7 "How to use the Auto Tester program" on page 7-31.
5-56 Section 5-14 - Service Page
GE DRAFT VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 DRAFT (DECEMBER 12, 2017) BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
5-14-3-2 Update
PRECONDITION: The first “Boot Device” in BIOS has to be Hard Disk Drive.
NOTE: During “FMI from DVD” the used system configuration (incl. Full Backup) will be stored on R:\.
If required, the previously used System configuration (before FMI from DVD was performed) can
be restored by activating the “Rollback” function. Operation see: Section 5-15-1-3 on page 5-60.
WARNING
WARNING If you select the YES button, all patients data, studies, images and measure report data
!! WARNING:
will be deleted permanently from the hard disk and cannot be recovered!
NOTE: Reconfigure the layout of the keyboard is only useful by changing the concerned keys also.
see: Section 8-46 "Replacement of AN KEY TOP" on page 8-118
Select the LOAD APPLICATION SETTINGS button on the “Service Tools” page to load proper
Application Settings (image presets), adapted for the used system software version.
NOTICE When reloading these Application Settings, any existing User Programs, 3D/4D Programs and Auto
!! NOTICE:
Text remain unaffected!
1.) Select the LOAD APPLICATION SETTINGS button on the “Service Tools” page (Figure 5-35 on
page 5-56).
2.) Choose the media and then click LOAD.
Choose media
and
NOTICE If the ID of the Application Setting is not valid for the currently installed Application Software version,
!! NOTICE:
a warning message “Application Settings from selected backup are not compatible with current system.
Application Settings have not be loaded.” appears during boot up sequence.
4.) If warning message is displayed, confirm it with OK and then load appropriate Application Settings
(perform loading procedure as described in steps above).
Section 5-15
Boot Screen Functions
5-15-1 Overview
Following LINUX supported functions are available as soon as the “Boot Screen” appears:
Voluson
GE-Service
Rollback
Memtest
NOTICE After 3 sec. without pressing any key, the system will boot-up in windows (= Voluson item).
!! NOTICE:
5-15-1-1 Voluson
The System will boot-up in windows. The Ultrasound Application is started.
For details refer to Section 3-6-2-3 "During a normal boot, you may observe" on page 3-28.
5-15-1-2 GE-Service
The Voluson Maintenance System functions are secured by service password (class C).
CAUTION After 3 sec. without pressing any key, the system will boot-up in windows (= Voluson item).
If you missed step 2, retry again with CTRL + ALT + DEL.
5-15-1-3 Rollback
This function offers the possibility to simply restore the previously used system configuration (rollback),
which was stored on R:\ during “FMI from DVD”.
select [OK]
5-15-1-4 Memtest
Starts the PC Memory Test.
Operation see: Section 5-16-10 "Memory Check in LINUX" on page 5-84.
Section 5-16
LINUX - Voluson Maintenance System
5-16-1 Overview
The Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 systems contains the “Voluson Maintenance system” with improved
possibility to perform extended PC Memtest (see: 5-16-10 "Memory Check in LINUX" on page 5-84).
General operation and selection in BIOS and LINUX menu is done with:
• the alphanumeric keyboard
• the “Arrow” keys [ left] , [ right] , PG UP [ up] , PG
DN [down] and
• the “Enter” key on the keyboard
5-16-2 Access/Security
There are different possibilities to access the LINUX “Maintenance System” and its available functions:
• System is still responsive: (starts up without problems, application software is running as usual)
* via Boot Screen Functions - GE Service: functions are secured by service password (class C)
* via Windows Start Menu (for GE Field Engineers ONLY): by means of service dongle and GE
password
CAUTION If the system is suspected to be infected with a virus, it is highly recommended to disconnect
the network cable before starting the system.
1.) Boot up the system, connect a probe and start any user program.
2.) Press the UTILITIES key on the control panel.
3.) In the Utilities menu, select SYSTEM SETUP to invoke the setup desktop on the screen.
4.) On the left side of the screen select ADMINISTRATION:
- Click the OPTIONS tab to see which options are currently installed in the system.
Please print out this page or write down the “Permanent Key”
NOTICE If the currently installed software has to be upgraded to a newer version, a new software specific
“Permanent key” is required.
- Click the SYSTEM INFO tab and check Software Version and date of the “Factory Settings”
(see:Section Figure 7-1 "System Setup - Administration - SYSTEM INFO page (e.g., VS8)"
on page 7-3 ).
For more details about “Full Backup” see: Section 4-5-3 on page 4-37.
For more details about saving the Patient Image Archive, see: Section 4-4-11 "Patient Archive
(Image Management)" on page 4-35
- Click the BUTTON CONFIGURATION tab and print out or write down the settings of this
page.
• the [DICOM Configuration] button and print out the “DICOM Configuration” dialog page or write
down the DICOM parameters (AE Title, Station Name, Retry Count and Retry Interval).
• the [Network Configuration] button and print out the “Internet Protocol (TCP/IP) Properties” dialog
page or write down the IP settings.
7.) On the left side of the screen select GENERAL:
5-62 Section 5-16 - LINUX - Voluson Maintenance System
GE DRAFT VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 DRAFT (DECEMBER 12, 2017) BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
- Click the GENERAL tab and print out or write down the settings of this page.
- Click the USER SETTINGS and print out or write down the settings of this page.
- Click the PATIENT INFO DISPLAY tab and print out or write down the settings of this page.
11.)Print out the APPLICATION PARAMETERS page or write down the settings of this dialog page.
12.)Print out the GLOBAL PARAMETERS page or write down the settings of this dialog page.
13.)Disconnect all external USB devices (e.g. USB printer).
The “Voluson Maintenance System” main menu with following functions appear:
Media Menu
Advanced Functions Menu
Exit/Reboot
5-16-4-1 Media
This item switches to the Media Menu (see: Section 5-16-5 "Media Menu" on page 5-65).
However, if it is necessary to create a “New Hard disk”, which contains factory default partition images
To change “Boot Priority order” in BIOS and setup new HDD, see: "NewDisk" on 5-68.
5-16-4-2 Advanced
This item switches to the Advanced Functions Menu (see: 5-16-6 "Advanced Functions Menu" on page
5-76).
5-16-4-3 About
This item displays various version strings from the Linux system.
5-16-4-4 Exit/Reboot
This item exits the maintenance system and reboots the system.
5-16-4-5 Halt
This item exits the maintenance system. Afterwards the power may safely be turned off.
1.) If system functionality allows it, collect vital system information as described in 5-16-3 "Before
Recovering or Initializing the Hard disk" on page 5-62.
2.) Insert the System DVD into the DVD/CD+R/RW Drive.
3.) In the “Voluson Maintenance System” main menu (Figure 5-40) select [Media].
The “Media Menu” with following functions appear:
Restore
Initialize
New Disk
Only available when
booting from DVD
5-16-5-1 Exit
Return to the “Voluson Maintenance System” main menu.
5-16-5-2 Restore
This function takes the image stored on the “System DVD” to replace the existing image of the “C”
partition. Additionally the (R:) Rescue image of (C:) is replaced by the “DVD image”.
NOTICE Data on the D: [User] partition (e.g., Patient Archive images, Service Database, Measurements,
Patient Data and Reports) will NOT be modified!
NOTICE If the currently installed software has to be upgraded to a newer version, a new software specific
“Permanent key” is required.
Chapter 5 - Components and Functions (Theory) 5-65
GE RAFT VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 DRAFT (DECEMBER 12, 2017) BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
Operation:
1.) Select [Restore] in the displayed “Media Menu” (see: Figure 5-41 above).
NOTE: If the message: “Recovery system (Linux) needs to be updated ...” appears, confirm with YES.
NOTE: If the currently installed software has to be upgraded to a newer version, a new software specific
“Permanent key” is required.
2.) Only if you are sure you have saved the “Full System Configuration”, select YES in the
following dialog box (see: Figure 5-42 below) and confirm with ENTER.
NOTE: If the message: “Found obsolete image files on R: .... “appears, select YES and confirm with ENTER.
5.) Remove the System DVD from the DVD/CD+R/RW Drive drive.
NOTICE The system boots with windows. An automated process was developed to check disk, assign an unique
computer name and matching drive letters. The system will reboot at least 2 times!
6.) Please wait until all processes are finished and the final “DOS” window (Figure 5-45 below) appear.
8.) If following message appears, skip the “BT warning” with CONTINUE.
NOTE: Options will be recovered at a later step using “Full Backup” process.
5-16-5-3 Initialize
This function performs operations which result in complete data loss of all files on C:\ and D:\
partition. The rescue image stored on the Rescue (R:) partition of the hard disk is replaced by the
WARNING
WARNING All data on D:\ (User) partition (e.g., Patient Archive images, Service Database,
Measurement results, Patient Data and Reports) will be deleted and re-initialized.
NOTICE If the currently installed software has to be upgraded to a newer version, a new software
specific”Permanent key” is required.
NOTICE The [Initialize] function should only be performed if NO System DVD is available!
If you have a System DVD, it is highly recommended to use the [New Disk] function
(see: Section 5-16-5-4 on page 5-68), which is only available when booting from the System DVD.
5-16-5-4 NewDisk
NOTE: This function is ONLY available when booting from System DVD.
This function performs operations which result in complete data loss of all files on the entire hard
disk. It re-initializes the hard disk using partition images on the System DVD (setup to factory default).
WARNING
WARNING COMPLETE DATA LOSS ON THE ENTIRE HARD DISK. Also data on D:\ [User] partition
(e.g., Patient Archive images, Service Database, Measurement results, Patient data and
Reports) will be lost and can not be carried over to the new hard disk.
• C:\ [System]: Windows XP with latest patches, Ultrasound Application Software [UIS],
Image Settings [Backup], Service Software [SSW] and Electronic User Manual [EUM]
• D:\ [User]: Initialized Databases for Measurements, Patient Archive Images, Data and Reports
• R:\ [Rescue]: Rescue image of C:\, Printer Driver
NOTICE Disconnect all external USB devices (e.g. USB printer, memory stick, etc.) - except the DVD Drive
before proceeding with the recovery.
NOTICE If the currently installed software has to be upgraded to a newer version, and the system DVD being
used is SW 14.0.0 or higher, a new software specific “Permanent key” is required.
NOTICE The BIOS “Boot Priority Order” Setting has to be changed before the New Hard Disk Setup.
NOTE: General operation and selection is done with the “Arrow” keys (right, left, up, down) and the “Enter”
key on the keyboard.
NOTE: When booting from System DVD, the Primary Master have to be the 1st Boot Device. Primary Master
is CD/DVD. Third Master is HDD.
5.) Use “Arrow” keys [left] or [right] on the alphanumeric keyboard to select the [Boot] tab.
6.) Using the keys PG UP [up] and PG DN [down] on the alphanumeric keyboard select 1st Boot
Device and then press ENTER.
NOTE: If not already done, change BIOS “Boot Priority Order” as described in Section 5-16-5-4-1 on page 5-69.
1.) Wait for automatic boot into the “Voluson Maintenance System”.
2.) In the displayed menus select [Media] -> [NewDisk] and then press ENTER.
NOTE: If the currently installed software has to be upgraded to a newer version, a new software specific
“Permanent key” is required.
4.) ONLY if you are absolutely sure, select YES and then confirm with ENTER.
NOTICE If you select YES, all data on the entire hard disk will be lost and can not be recovered!
This includes all stored images and patient data!
Please wait until the final window (Figure 5-52 below) appears and then press ENTER.
7.) During startup, press the DEL key immediately, to enter the BIOS Setup.
8.) Using the keyboard set “Boot Device Priority” order back to 1. boot device: Hard Disk:
- BIOS Setup Utility (Congatec Dual-core PC-Motherboard installed):
1st Boot Device [P0-xxx] = HDD = Third Master
9.) Exit and Save BIOS Settings: Confirm the “Save configuration changes and exit now?” message
with YES and ENTER. The system boots with windows.
NOTICE An automated process was developed to check disk, assign an unique computer name and matching
drive letters. The system will reboot at least 2 times!
10.)Wait until all processes are finished and the final “DOS” window (Figure 5-54 below) appear.
Exit
NOTE: This Linux screen doesn't show "Restore" and "Intialize", because system was booted from System
DVD)
5-16-6-1 Exit
Return to the “Voluson Maintenance System” main menu.
5-16-6-2 Network
This item provides an easy interface for network setup.
5-16-6-3 SSHD
By selecting this item, a SSH-daemon is started on the system.
The [SSHD] function is reserved for extended troubleshooting. Not intended for use in the field.
5-16-6-4 Restore
This function takes the image stored on the Rescue (R:) partition to replace the existing image of the
“C” partition.
NOTE: Data on the D: [User] partition (e.g., Patient Archive images, Measurement results, Patient Data and
NOTICE The [Restore] function should only be performed if NO System DVD is available!
If you have a System DVD, please select the [Restore] function that is available in the
CD-ROM Functions Menu; see:Section 5-16-5 on page 5-65
partition. The image on the on the Rescue (R:) partition of the hard disk is used for restoring C:\.
NOTICE The [Restore] function should only be performed if NO System DVD is available!
If you have a System DVD, please select the [Restore] function that is available in the CD-ROM
Functions Menu; see:Section 5-16-5 on page 5-65), which is only available when booting from the
System DVD
WARNING
WARNING All data on D:\ (User) partition (e.g., Patient Archive images, Measurement results,
Patient Data and Reports) will be deleted and re-initialized.
NOTICE The [Initialize] function should only be performed if NO System DVD is available!
If you have a System DVD, it is highly recommended to use the [New Disk] function (see:Section 5-
16-5-4 on page 5-68), which is only available when booting from the System DVD
5-16-6-6 ServiceTools
Service Tools Menu, see: Section 5-16-7 on page 5-78
5-16-7-1 Exit
Return to the “Advanced Functions Menu”.
5-16-7-2 Shell
By selecting this item, a Bash-shell is opened. Enter “exit” to return to the main menu.
The [Shell] function is not intended for use in the field.
5-16-7-3 USBTree
The USB Tree displays connected devices and their respective hub.
This enables easy control, whether all devices are correctly wired.
5-16-7-4 SmartHDDtest
This item starts the SMART (Self Monitoring, Analysis and Reporting Technology) long test.
It gathers data about the hard disk´s performance and operations, detects and reports various indicators
of reliability, in the hope of anticipating failures.
NOTE: This test takes about 1-3 hours (depending on the HDD size).
5-16-7-5 HDDWipeTool
By means of this function all data (e.g., patient data, archive images, measurement results and reports)
on the hard disk will be removed and overwritten with zeros!
WARNING
WARNING COMPLETE DATA LOSS ON THE ENTIRE HARD DISK.
!! WARNING:
There is no possibility to restore the data!!!
NOTICE This should be performed before sending hard drives/BEPs back to GPRS for PHI data reasons.
5-16-7-6 CollectLogs
Voluson Log files can be stored on an USB-stick. The stored zip file includes the current system state
(as “Full Backup”), Process Logger files, Auto tester files, SMART logs, dump files, etc.
3.) If saving is done, a message that log was saved successfully will be appeared.
2.) On a Laptop/PC:
* Copy all necessary files of the LogViewer (*.dll) to a directory and Execute the File
“VolusonLogViewer.exe”.
* Browse/select for the LogFile(s) which have to be analyzed (“log-voluson_00000x.txt”)
The benefit of this LogViewer is the clearly arranged presentation of Voluson Log-Files (“log-
voluson_00000x.txt”) with search and filtering functions.
1.) If not currently done, restart the system (with new HDD) and boot up completely.
2.) Connect the USB “standard GE” service dongle to the USB connector(s) on the rear of the system.
As soon as the dongle is detected the login window pops up.
3.) Enter the “Standard GE Revolving” password (changes every six months) and click ENABLE.
4.) Connect a probe and start any user program.
5.) Press UTILITIES and then select the SYSTEM SETUP item.
6.) On the left side of the screen select BACKUP:
- click the IMAGE ARCHIVE tab to reload the Patient Image Archive,
operation see: Section 4-5-7-2 on page 4-50.
NOTE: Reloading the Image Settings only (Application Settings) should ONLY be performed, if:
NOTE: Reloading a “Full Backup” into the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 system is ONLY possible, if:
If you have reloaded the “Full Backup” step 8.) to step 9.) as well as step 13.) to step 14.)
7.) On the left side of the screen select ADMINISTRATION, click the OPTIONS tab and enter the codes
for the options as described in "Section Section 8-7 "Replacement or Activation of Options" on page
8-22.
8.) On the left side of the screen select GENERAL:
- Click the GENERAL tab and check and match settings (according to printout).
- Click the USER SETTINGS and check and match settings (according to printout).
- Click the PATIENT INFO DISPLAY tab and check and match settings (according to printout).
NOTICE Save any presets, configurations and settings to HDD and/or DVD, etc. to have it available for next time.
Operation see: Section 4-5-4 "Save Full System Configuration (Full Backup)" on page 4-43" .
NOTICE After 3 sec. without pressing any key, the system will boot-up in windows.
!! NOTICE:
If you missed step 1, retry again with CTRL + ALT + DEL.
The PC Memory Test will start automatically and will take about 0.5 hours.
If there are errors they will be listed.
list of errors
NOTICE After one cycle (~ 0.5 hours) the memory check starts again. To interrupt the test, press the ESC key.
!! NOTICE:
If you don’t interrupt the memory test by pressing the ESC key, it will perform never ending cycles of
memory checks.
NOTE: If after one cycle (about 0.5 hours), no error messages are listed, it can be assumed that the Back End
Processor including power supply is working properly.
Chapter 6
Service Adjustments
Section 6-1
Overview
6-1-1 Purpose of Chapter 6
This chapter describes how to test and adjust the mechanical capabilities of a scanner that may be out
of specification. Although some tests may be optional they should only be performed by qualified
personnel.
Section 6-2
Regulatory
Verify, where applicable, that any regulatory information or tests required by national law are present
and accounted for, and any regulatory tests required by national law are performed and documented.
Section 6-3
LCD Monitor Adjustment
NOTE: From BT15 system, it's accessible via not monitor adjustment but monitor menu on application. Please
refer to Section 6-3-1.
3.) Select RGB tab. Adjust Color Temperature Presets and press OK.
Section 6-4
Modification of Keyboard Layout
NOTE: Configuring the layout of the keyboard is only useful by changing the concerned keys also.
[Keyboard Layout]
button
6.) Select default input language from the drop down menu.
NOTE: If the desired language is not listed, click the ADD button, choose the desired input language from the
drop down menu, as shown in Figure 6-6 below, and then confirm with OK.
7.) If not already done, select the default input language from the drop down menu (see: Figure 6-5).
The corresponding keyboard layout is changed automatically.
8.) Click on APPLY and then close the window with OK.
9.) Close the Service page with the SAVE & EXIT and restart the system.
10.)Reenter “Keyboard Layout” by repeating step 1.) to step 6.). This time remove unused language(s)
11.)Test the Keyboard function:
- Press the ABC key on the control panel.
- Press some keys on the keyboard and verify the entered text.
Chapter 7
Diagnostics/Troubleshooting
Section 7-1
Overview
7-1-1 Purpose of Chapter 7
This section describes how to setup and run the tools and software that help maintain image quality and
system operation. Basic host, system, and board level diagnostics are run whenever power is applied.
Some Service Tools may be run at the application level.
7-1-2 Overview
There may be a time when it would be advantageous to capture trouble images and system data (logs)
for acquisition through remote diagnostics or to be sent back to the manufacturer for analysis. There
are different options to acquire this data that would give different results.
7-5-2 How the Customer enables/disables Disruptive Mode and VCO 7-16
Section 7-2
Collect Vital System Information
1.) Press the UTILITIES key on the control panel.
2.) In the “Utilities” menu select SYSTEM SETUP to invoke the setup desktop on the screen.
3.) On the left side of the screen select ADMINISTRATION and then click the SYSTEM INFO tab.
The following information is necessary in order to properly analyze data or images being reported as a
malfunction or being returned to the manufacturer:
• System Type
• System Serial number (also visible on label on the back of the system)
• Application Software version
• Backup Version (File Name, Date of Factory Settings, Tune version, etc.)
• additional information (e.g., Hardware ID, “Mainboard Type”, HW configuration, etc.)
NOTE: All the above information can be found in the System Info page; see: Figure 7-1 on page 7-3.
System Type
Serial number
Hardware ID
Application
Software
Mainboard Type
(e.g., Congatec)
Move the scroll bars downwards to view additional information about installed software/hardware
(e.g., Console information).
Figure 7-1 System Setup - Administration - SYSTEM INFO page (e.g., VS8)
• by means of the GE “Remote Status Icon” that is displayed on the bottom of the screen.
Move the cursor to the GE icon and press the left trackball key (= left-click) to display the
“Request For Service” form (see: Figure 7-2 below).
[Send] button
Connection must
be Checked out
4.) Click the SEND button to send the problem description to GE Service/Application representatives.
5.) Write down and keep the Reference Number for follow up procedures, then click OK.
NOTE: If the service platform is not configured an Error message is displayed. The request is NOT sent!
Shortcut Description
Ctrl + C copy text
Section 7-3
Check Points Voltages
7-3-1 How to check power
LED
NOTE: If LED is on, CPS has full function (all voltages are within the specified range).
Section 7-4
Screen Captures and Logs
There may be times when the customer or field engineer will want to capture a presentation on the
screen so it may be recovered by the OnLine Center. This is accomplished by saving the image(s):
A.) to Archive and export them (as jpg, bmp or tiff) to DVD/CD+R/RW or external USB drive.
B.) as jpg and bmp to D:\export by pressing the ALT + P key on the alphanumeric keyboard.
Note: Successive ALT + P keystrokes (max. 20) overwrite existing snapshots at destination HDD!
C.) creates one snapshot (Alt-D.bmp) + “Full Backup” of the System state (fullbackup -> fb1) saved by
pressing the ALT + D key on the alpha-numeric keyboard.
NOTE: A short summary of P1, P2, P3 and P4 key´s configuration is shown in the status area on the screen.
3.) Select the stored image(s) and export them to DVD/CD+R/RW, an external USB drive (optional) or
mapped Network drive (jpg, avi, mov, bmp, tif, Voluson format file, Volume files and DICOM files).
NOTE: Logs collected should be stored under D:export to ensure that these sniffer logs will be included in the
zip file when you perform ALT+ D or export system data via System Setup - Administration - SERVICE.
1.) On the Regular Scan Screen, press ALT + N. This launches the network sniffer application.
2.) On the network sniffer screen select Capture -> Options.
3.) Choose your Network in the “Interface” drop-down menu (Intel Network or Wireless adapter).
NOTE: Remember, if the device has a DVR, it will show up in the “Interface” list.
4.) If desired, select a “Capture Filter” from the drop-down menu; refer to Section 7-4-2-1 on page 7-12.
Note:
If you are working with
a Wireless connection, you
must uncheck the
“Capture packets in
promiscuous mode”.
The wireless option
does not support this mode.
5.) Adjust “Display Options” for best performance to avoid packet loss on high throughput.
6.) Select START.
Filter
A "Packet List" pane - the packet list pane displays all the packets in the current capture file.
Each line in the packet list corresponds to one packet in the capture file.
"Packet Details" pane - shows the current packet (selected in the "Packet List" pane) in a more detailed form.
B
This pane shows the protocols and protocol fields of the packet selected in the "Packet List" pane.
C "Packet Bytes" pane - The packet bytes pane shows the data of the current packet (selected in the "Packet List" pane)
in a hexdump style.
9.) In addition use the filter tool on the screen to filter what is displayed. Filter the DICOM packets, since
they are the most probable for the troubleshooting; refer to Section 7-4-2-2 on page 7-13.
10.)Select Capture -> Stop, or select the icon in the task bar to stop the capture.
NOTICE If you have used a screen filter (refer to Section 7-4-2-2 on page 7-13), select “Displayed”. This will save
only the filtered values rather than the entire capture.
!! NOTICE:
12.)Click SAVE.
NOTE: Wireshark uses lipcap (*.pcap, *.cap) file format as the default format to save captured packets. (If you
need to open this file with D-Trace or DVTK, the capture can be resaved in NA Sniffer Windows format).
13.)Exit the sniffer application by clicking on the [X] in the upper right corner.
14.)If you have already performed Save as, you can continue without saving and quit the program.
by IP only
Filter Apply
1.) by pressing the ALT + D key to save a snapshot and “Full Backup” of the System state;
see: Section 7-4-3-1 on page 7-14
2.) via the EXPORT SYSTEM DATA button in the System Setup - Administration - SERVICE page;
see: Section 7-4-3-2 on page 7-15
Data can be stored on the hard disk (D:\export\fullbackup\fb1), or you can export them to DVD/CD.
Including the D:\export folder, which contains dump files (for details see: Section 7-4-3-2-1),
Process Logger files, Autotester files, SMART logs and Screenshots [Alt + P].
NOTE: Successive ALT + D keystrokes overwrite existing snapshots (Alt-D.bmp) at destination HDD.
Export
System Data
7.) Click on the EXPORT SYSTEM DATA... button to Full Backup the System State. This includes
dump files (see: Section 7-4-3-2-1) and text files, full Service Database informations about probes,
boards, Software, Options and the Event Log File.
7-4-3-2-1 Dump-file
Every time an error message like Figure 7-17 is produced, a dump-file and a text file containing the
error dump and the error message are created in D:\export. Up to 20 dump files are stored there.
important
dump-file
informations
Section 7-5
Remote Access to Service Platform
7-5-1 General
This offers GE technicians the possibility to view the entire customer´s desktop and operation system.
Using VCO (Virtual Console Observation) a service technician or the OnLine Center can access and
modify all PC settings and programs or run diagnostics on the customer´s ultrasound scanner.
NOTICE Remote access is ONLY possible if the service platform is properly configured (either by the user
!! NOTICE:
or a GE technician at site). Operation see: Section 7-5-7 "CSD: Configuration" on page 7-29.
Remote access to the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 scanner requires permission and customer input
before a GE service technician or OLC can access the customer’s ultrasound scanner remotely.
“Disruptive Mode” can be selected by the customer directly on the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6
ultrasound system (see: Section 7-5-2 on page 7-16), or remotely by the service technician or OLC.
Cancel (disable)
GE icon
4.) If you select Cancel, "Disruptive Mode" and "VCO" is turned OFF.
NOTE: Visual information about GE remote service status is shown in the status area on the right bottom of the
screen.
NOTE: If the customer does not wish to have diagnostics running at the time of the request, select Cancel. A
message is sent back to the OLC or FE that permission to change Disruptive Status is denied.
NOTICE The system may require a correct proxy configuration. Please ask the customer.
!! NOTICE:
2.) If available and required enter the correct proxy server address and then click [OK].
3.) The next window shows the command to be issued, click on [OK] to grant the request.
The “virtual” Monitor of the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 is displayed on your remote workstation screen.
Toolbar with
useful options
The tool bar on top of the virtual monitor screen contains useful options.
Press the CTRL + H key on the alphanumeric keyboard, to display a list of shortcuts available when
• to “release” the mouse cursor, press the shortcut CTRL + M (Mode Control On/Off Toggle function)
• to display the system setup, press the shortcut ALT + SHIFT + S
• to display the Console Emulator (see: Figure 7-32 on page 7-27), press the shortcut ALT + S
NOTE: For complete shortcut list refer to Section 7-2-2 "Shortcuts List" on page 7-6.
Press the shortcut ALT + S on the alphanumeric keyboard, to display the Console Emulator.
NOTE: For description of keys and their functions refer to Section 5-6-2 "OPIO layout" on page 5-33.
NOTE: To regain free sight to the monitor image, the virtual Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 console disappears
as soon as you select a button. It is simply hidden in the background. Press the shortcut ALT + S twice
to show it again.
NOTE: As described in Chapter 5 - Common Service Desktop (CSD), on page 5-52, the service platform uses
a web-based user interface (UI) to provide access to common service components.
The Service platform is designed for GE personnel and as such is in English only.
There is no multi-lingual capability built into the Service Interface.
NOTICE If a Proxy server is available, the information MUST be properly entered, otherwise remote control
!! NOTICE:
does not work. There is no possibility to detect proxy server information automatically.
1.) Ask the hospital's network Administrator for the Proxy Server Address and the Proxy Server Port.
2.) Select the Configuration page, then double-click “InSite ExC Agent Configuration”.
3.) Fill out all bold stated “mandatory” fields.
4.) Enter Proxy Server Address and Proxy Server Port.
5.) Click the SUBMIT CHANGES button and then close the service page.
NOTE:
1.) It requires all bold fields should be filled out. The mandatory are :
1.) Device Name (Not Change)
2.) CRM No
3.) Continent
4.) Country
5.) City
6.) State(Prov)
7.) Enterprise Server
8.) Service Center
9.) File watcher
10.)Proxy and Proxy Authentication (If it requires)
2.) Device name is pre-populated. Do not change this Value.
3.) Requires IP addresses Loaded in "Other" for the Advanced configuration setting.
4.) These devices will not resolve using Domain Name Servers (DNS).
5.) You can confirm that the system is "checked out" by looking at the CSD homepage. Sometimes it
may take 1 min for this to change.
BT Version: At BT15 systems (SW 14.0.0) the Process Logger installation file (install.bat) as well as the installation
manual (KTI7R786) can be found on the internal HDD´s partition R:\system\uisapp\Processlogger.
1.) If not available on the HDD, download the Process Logger installation file from GE folders, http://
libraries.ge.com/foldersIndex.do?entity_id=18661356101&sid=101&SF=1 and save it on CD.
2.) Install and use the Process Logger as described in the Installation Manual (KTI7R786; available at
GE Folders, the CDL, the System DVD or the internal HDD´s partition R:\).
Section 7-7
How to use the Auto Tester program
1.) Press the UTILITIES key on the control panel.
2.) In the “Utilities” menu select SYSTEM SETUP to invoke the setup desktop on the screen.
3.) If not already done, connect the USB “standard GE” service dongle to the USB connector(s) on the
rear of the system. As soon as the dongle is detected the login window pops up.
4.) Enter the “Standard GE Revolving” password (changes every six months) and then click ENABLE.
5.) On the left side of the screen select ADMINISTRATION and then click the SERVICE tab.
6.) Click the SERVICE TOOLS button on the Service window to get access to the “Service Tools” page.
[Start]
Auto Tester
“Record”
icon
11.)Start scanning.
You can scan normally and everything will be recorded to the program (up to several hours.)
NOTE: It is important that you are recording the processes where the errors normally occur.
12.)Insert an empty DVD/CD+R/RW in the Drive and select the “DVD/CD Burn” icon.
Or hit “Disc icon” to save to export.
13.)Enter a Filename.
15.)After the DVD/CD write is finished click the OK button and then close the “Auto Tester” program.
7-26 Section 7-7 - How to use the Auto Tester program
GE DRAFT VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 DRAFT (DECEMBER 12, 2017) BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
Section 7-8
How to repair Databases (*.mdb)
A small database repair tool opens and compacts all relevant databases on D:\ [User].
This is a last remedial action (when experiencing database problems), before overwriting the database
with empty files.
CAUTION Before starting this tool, all programs that access the databases MUST be closed!
1.) Connect the USB “standard GE” service dongle on the front USB connector(s). As soon as the
dongle is detected, the login window pops up. Remove the dongle.
2.) Enter the “Standard GE Revolving” password (changes every six months) and click ENABLE.
3.) Press CTRL + SHIFT + ESC simultaneously to open the Windows Task Manager.
4.) Switch to the PROCESSES tab.
Processes tab
sort by name
select process
(e.g., UISApp.exe)
5.) Click on the “Image Name” column to sort the “Processes” by name.
6.) Select “UISApp.exe” and if present, kill it with the END PROCESS button.
7.) Select “Transfer.exe” and if present, kill it with the END PROCESS button.
It reports on the actions it performs. This can be valuable information for the technicians. Check that all
databases (.mdb) are repaired (see:Figure 7-42).
10.)In case of any failures, please make a screen shot (press ALT + P key, to save it to D:\export), print
out or write down the error message and then close the program by pressing ENTER.
11.)Close all open windows (e.g., Windows Explorer).
12.)Restart the system (turn off and on the system).
Section 7-9
Hardware Tests
1.) Press UTILITIES key on the control panel.
2.) In the UTILITIES menu, press SYSTEM SETUP button to invoke the setup desktop on the sceen.
3.) If not already done, connect the USB “standard GE” service dongle to the USB connector(s) on the
system. As soon as the dongle is detected, the login window pops up.
4.) Enter the "Standard GE Revolving" password (changes every six months) and the click ENABLE.
5.) On the left side of the screen, select ADMINISTRATION and then click the SERVICE tab.
6.) Click the SERVICE TOOLS button on the Service window to get access to the "Service Tools" page.
Hardware
Test
NOTE: The "System Diagnostics Tool"(see: Figure 7-46 on page 7-37 ) appears on the screen.
Automatic/Not-Automatic diagnostic tests are executed from this System Diagnostics Tool.
Run Test
Button
Diagnostic
Log
Window
Exit Button
Restart
Application
Shutdown
System
System Information Area
Table 7-1 below outlines Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Diagnostics Tool described in the sub-sections.
Table 7-1 Diagnostic Tool
WARNING
WARNING It doesn't matter if there is an error message after a test application - these are special
!! WARNING:
test conditions - Restart the system.
1.) Select the AUDIO(SYSTEM) INTERFACE TEST button in the Diagnostics Tool window.
2.) Check if there is hearable audio sound from Speaker and AudioOutput port on rear panel.
1.) Select the AUDIO(DOPPLER) INTERFACE TEST button in the Diagnostics Tool window.
2.) Check if there is hearable beep audio sound from Speaker and AudioOutput port on rear panel.
• Connect a probe and then press the FREEZE key to "run" the live scan (Write Mode).
• Select the PATTERNGEN button (Pattern Generator) in the System Diagnostics Tools window.
The pattern data are fed in the RFS board. If pattern is shown correctly like below picture, this means
that the whole BackEnd digital scan converter part of RFS is ok.
7-9-3-1 Troubleshooting
• Pattern is shown correctly:
a.) Perform "Channel Test Diagnostics", see Channels Overall Test on page 7-53.
• Pattern is shown irregular:
a.) Perform "RFS Diagnostics", see RFS Overall Test on page 7-48.
NOTE: To distinguish if it is a board problem, or if the probe is defective, it would be helpful to have an additional
probe on site.
Missing channels or elements can easily be detected as dark shadows(shots with low intensity) from
Ultrasound image.
When exceeding the critical temperature, a warning message is displayed on the screen.
1.) Select the TEMPERATURE TEST button in the Diagnostics Tool window. (see : Figure 7-50 below).
The current system temperature is displayed.
2.) Using the "arrow up"(up) and/or "arrow down"(down) button, set the threshold of the "critical"
temperature below the currently shown system temperature.
For example: currently shown temperature is 33.9°C, so set the threshold of "critical" temperature
to 30°C.
After approx. 30 seconds, a warning message is displayed (see : Figure 7-51 below).
After 15 minutes, a second warning message is displayed. (see : Figure 7-52 below).
The threshold of the "critical" temperature automatically changes back to 60 Celsius after closing
Temperature Test Dialog.
1.) Select the CHARGE/DISCHARGE TEST button in the Diagnostics Tool window. (see : Figure 7-53
below).
The charge/discharge test dialog is displayed.
7.) Then it displays the test result(PASSED or FAILED) at the end of test(see : Figure 7-55 below).
1.) Select the desired test item from "Selection Combo Box" in Diagnostics Tool window.
2.) Select the desired execution loop count from "Test Loop Count" button.
3.) Execute the diagnostic test by selecting the RUN TEST button.
4.) Then it displays the test result (PASSED or FAILED) at the end of each diagnostic test.
Whenever executing the diagnostic test from System Diagnostics Tool, its execution log message will
be displayed in Log Window, and saved also in log file located in D:\Export\diagnosis.txt with execution
time-stamp.
Overall Test like "RFS - Overall Test" means that it executes sub-diagnostic test items one by one
automatically.
Table 7-2 below outlines Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Diagnostics Tool described in the sub-sections.
Table 7-2 Automatic diagnostic Test
Table 7-3 below outlines Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Diagnostics Tool described in the sub-sections.
Table 7-3 Automatic diagnostic test under RFS Test
7-9-7-2-15 HW ID Test
It verifies HW ID configuration on RFS board, and displays the current HW ID and the test result as
PASSED/FAILED.
Table 7-4 below outlines Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Diagnostics Tool described in the sub-sections.
Table 7-4 Automatic diagnostic test under BF Test
Table 7-5 below outlines Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Diagnostics Tool described in the sub-sections.
Table 7-5 Automatic diagnostic test under PIRIII Test
Table 7-6 below outlines Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Diagnostics Tool described in the sub-sections.
Table 7-6 Automatic diagnostic test under CPS Test
Table 7-7 below outlines Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Diagnostics Tool described in the sub-sections.
Table 7-7 Automatic diagnostic test under DC4D Test
Table 7-8 below outlines Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Diagnostics Tool described in the sub-sections.
Table 7-8 Automatic diagnostic test under Channel Test
Table 7-9 below outlines Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Diagnostics Tool described in the sub-sections.
Table 7-9 Automatic diagnostic test under ECG Test
Table 7-10 below outlines Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Diagnostics Tool described in the sub-sections.
Table 7-10 Automatic diagnostic test under OPIO Test
NOTE: This VPD information is set by Manufacturer since Mizar BT12. In case of Mizar BT11 OPIO, this
information could be empty. In that case, the test result as PASSED with blank information.
Table 7-11 below outlines Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Diagnostics Tool described in the sub-sections.
Table 7-11 Automatic diagnostic test under Battery Test
Table 7-12 below outlines Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Diagnostics Tool described in the sub-sections.
Table 7-12 Automatic diagnostic test under LCDMON Test
Section 7-10
Minimum Configuration to Boot/Scan
7-10-1 Booting without using the Ultrasound Hardware
If the low-level ultrasound hardware is failing, the application can not be initialized correctly.
Consequently, proper boot-up of the system is prevented.
By steadily pressing the H key on the alphanumeric keyboard during startup, the application can be
started, even if the ultrasound-hardware is broken.
The hardware is not initialized; the application simply does not get ultrasound data into process.
However, one can use the Image Archive function to save patient archive and images, and to gather
system information by saving a "Full Backup". The remote service capabilities are also present.
Operation:
1.) Power On / Boot Up the system as described in Section 3-6-2 "Power On / Boot Up" on page 3-25.
2.) As soon as the start-up process bar indicates "Initialization of Voluson", press the H key on the
Alphanumeric keyboard.
3.) Keep the H key pressed during complete startup (~ 1 minute). Following message appears:
4.) Click on CONTINUE. The "Probe Selection" menu appears on the screen.
5.) Press the FREEZE key. The application starts, but does not show any Ultrasound information.
6.) Backup all images (see:Section 4-5-7 "Archiving Images" on page 4-48).
7.) Save a "Full Backup" as described in Section 4-5-4 "Save Full System Configuration (Full Backup)"
on page 4-43) or press the ALT+D key to gather detailed information and data from the system.
(see: Section 7-4-3-1 "Export System Data (by pressing the ALT + D key)" on page 7-14).
8.) Press the UTILITES key on the control panel and select SYSTEM SETUP to invoke setup desktop.
9.) Select ADMINISTRATION, open the SYSTEM INGO page and click REBOOT MACHINE.
Section 7-11
User Interface Troubleshooting
Console Test
Status Window
NOTE: For description of keys and their functions as well as the key code numbers refer to: Figure 5-6-2: OPIO
layout on page 5-33The "MizarConsole - Console Tester" window is displayed.
GET VERSION The Console version is shown in the Status window on the screen.
The CLEAR LED’S button sets all LED’s off. (The illumination of all hardkeys is switched off.)
Section 7-12
Troubleshooting Trees, Instructions and Tech Tips
Table 7-13 below outlines Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 troubleshooting trees and instructions shown in
the sub-sections.
Table 7-13 Troubleshooting Trees and Instructions
Verify that
Is Standby Switch No - Power Cord is connected to Mains
illuminated? - Power Switch is turned on
(on the backside of the system)
Yes
Is Standby Switch
orange?
Yes
No
Press Standby Switch till it
changes to green System
starts booting
Yes
Yes
Check probes.
YES
Fixing
Close Ring Open
No image/No signal Check the main panel cable is properly connected to RFS.
For further details refer to Section 6-3 "LCD Monitor Adjustment" on page 6-2.
[Archive]
choose “Source”
select Exam
(with images)
3.) On the left side of the screen select ARCHIVE as shown in Figure 7-69 ABOVE.
4.) If not already selected, choose Source “Local Archive” Drive from the pop-up menu.
5.) Select an Exam (with images).
step b.)
choose “Source”
step c.)
step e.)
step d.)
step a.)
7.) After successful export, choose Source “4DV” from the pop-up menu.
8.) The images, which you have chosen to export should be visible.
Green = Cable connected to a network. Does not imply proper network settings.
1.) Check that the network cable between the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 system and the wall
network is connected and well seated in both ends. (Use a network cable that is known to be OK.)
2.) Connect a network cable between the system and a PC by either using a hub or a cross-over cable.
Try to ping from system to IP address on PC. If OK, hardware connection inside the system is OK.
Solution: 1.) Perform SonoView Backup on VolusonTM 730/Expert/Pro/ProV to external hard disk (USB) or DVD
2.) Import File "V730.mdb" from external hard disk (USB) or CD/DVD on Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6
Procedure:
1.) Connect external hard disk or insert CD/DVD on the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6.
2.) Open Archive --> select "Data Transfer" --> "Import". The "Open File" window appears
[Open]
Section 7-13
Error Messages
NOTICE If the problem (error message) still exists after performing the described actions, call technical support.
!! NOTICE:
A USB-drive has been removed without stopping it. Unplugging or ejecting devices
press Ok, and stop it before removing it next time
without first stopping them can often cause crashes and lose valuable data.
Application setting dynamic set field count mismatch restart the system
AVI Save function fails Action: check the connection and Power cable - restart the
see error message
machine and try again
B_Enhance Out Of Range press ok and save this user-setting once again
B_Gain Out Of Range press ok and save this user-setting once again
B_Reject Out Of Range press ok and save this user-setting once again
BC Ensemble Out Of Range press ok and save this user-setting once again
BC_Dynamic Out Of Range press ok and save this user-setting once again
BC_Gain Out Of Range press ok and save this user-setting once again
BCMC_Balance Out Of Range press ok and save this user-setting once again
B-DynContrast Out Of Range press ok and save this user-setting once again
binary file not found Action: restart the system restart the system
bPWCW_ProcessPWCWData in RT_PWorCWFilterBlock::bFilteredSamples
AddedToWorkingBuffer() returned error code xxx!! restart the system
Action: restart the system, If after restart not ok then call technical support
Cannot read a valid Probe-ID (xx) from Attempt to read Probe-ID from an invalid
restart the system, connect another probe
probe connector. Action: restart system
Cannot read a valid Probe-ID (xx) from left probe connector (A). Connect another probe
Cannot read a valid Probe-ID (xx) from middle probe connector (B). Connect another probe
Cannot read a valid Probe-ID (xx) from right probe connector (C). Connect another probe
Cannot read a valid Probe-ID (xx) from lower-left probe connector (CW). Connect another probe
Can't add chosen files to the virtual folders! restart the system
Can't open: patterndat.bin Action: restart the system restart the system
Can't open: resampcoef.bin Action: restart the system restart the system
Communication thread is dead! Action: Restart the system. restart the system; check connection from system to VCR,
Check connection from System to Recorder, Recorder has power and is on. VCR has power and is on
CPI-mode is only with curved probe Action: Contact technical support restart the system
CW_BaseLinePos Out Of Range Press ok and save this user-setting once again.
CW_Gain Out Of Range Press ok and save this user-setting once again.
CW-hardware doesn't support pencil probe + CWHardware not available, restart the system
Data are not saved or sent to DICOM Server! restart the system
Density Out Of Range Press ok and save this user-setting once again.
Different software error (Backup data was made on another system with a different
This backup cannot be restored by the user.
software version.)
Downgrade error (Backup data was made with a software version higher than the
load appropriate backup for installed version
installed version.)
DVD Recorder communication error! Check Recorder cables and try again.
check DVD connections, check if DVD is switched on
Make sure DVD Recorder is connected to US machine.
DVD Recorder timeout error! Check Recorder cables, DVD,... and try again. check DVD connections, check if DVD is switched on
Electronic user manual not installed. Please install. install Electronic User Manual (EUM) and try it again
Enhance Out Of Range press ok and save this user-setting once again
Error in execution due to: %s, please call technical support. restart the system
Error in ProbeTxFocusData. Action: Please contact technical support Please contact technical support
Error in ProbeTxFocusData. Action: Please contact technical support Please contact technical support
Error not enough time for BC shot! Action: restart the system restart the system
FallSmooth Out Of Range press ok and save this user-setting once again
File Could not CRC Check. Action: Load volume files from other storage medium. load volume files from other storage medium
File CRC Error. Action: Load volume files from other storage medium. load volume files from other storage medium
File CRC Missing. Action: Load volume files from other storage medium. load volume files from other storage medium
File Data Missing. Action: Load volume files from other storage medium. load volume files from other storage medium
File Decompress Error. Action: Load volume files from other storage medium. load volume files from other storage medium
File End Error. Action: Load volume files from other storage medium. load volume files from other storage medium
File Memory Missing. Action: Load volume files from other storage medium. load volume files from other storage medium
File Not Found. Action: Load volume files from other storage medium. load volume files from other storage medium
File Pos. Action: Load volume files from other storage medium. load volume files from other storage medium
File Read Error. Action: Load volume files from other storage medium. load volume files from other storage medium
File Type Unknown. Action: Load volume files from other storage medium. load volume files from other storage medium
FilterBuffer " Memory allocation failed". Action: please restart the system restart the system
GeckoBF: Wave Form Table wasn't found! Unknown Wave Form Table Key!
restart the system
Action: Restart the System!
GeoDescriptionMotion Constructor: unknown mode Parameter handed over restart the system
GeoDescriptionTissueCF Constructor: unknown mode Parameter handed over restart the system
hardware error on <var> Action: restart the system restart the system
In the 3D Image Measure is not allowed change to another format than 3D Fullscreen mode
LineFilt Out Of Range press ok and save this user-setting once again
Loading DVD data..... Requested operation could not be executed! Press ok, wait until loading process is finished and try
Try again after DVD data is loaded. again
M_Gain Out Of Range press ok and save this user-setting once again
M_Reject Out Of Range press ok and save this user-setting once again
MC Ensemble Out Of Range press ok and save this user-setting once again
MC_Balance Out Of Range press ok and save this user-setting once again
MC_BaseLinePos Out Of Range press ok and save this user-setting once again
MC_Dynamic Out Of Range press ok and save this user-setting once again
MC_FallSmooth Out Of Range press ok and save this user-setting once again
MC_Gain Out Of Range press ok and save this user-setting once again
MC_RiseSmooth Out Of Range press ok and save this user-setting once again
MCShotBuffer : not enough memory reserved" ". Action: restart the system restart the system
M-DynContrast Out Of Range press ok and save this user-setting once again
memory allocation error Action: restart the system restart the system
missing ProbeAcousticUnit, wrong ProbeAcousticUnitID. Action: restart the system restart the system
missing ProbeGeneral data - wrong ProbeID. Action: restart the system restart the system
missing ProbeScanFunc - wrong ProbeScanFuncID. Action: restart the system restart the system
No Cassette in drive! Put cassette into drive of VCR. Put cassette into the VCR
check the connection and the Power cable - plug the cable
No CD Writer found
off and on and try again. (restart the system)
No default settings available - use "Edit Settings" to set the Default Settings! select a printer
insert disk, if fails again reboot and try again (with another
No disc or device not ready!
disk)
No DVD in drive! Put DVD into drive of Recorder. Put DVD into drive
Not enough space. (Not enough space on destination to hold the backup data.) select another destination to save Full Backup
overview window creation failed. Action: restart the system restart the system
Password contains invalid characters. Allowed characters are A..Z, a..z, 0..9 and . Enter password without invalid characters
Password is too short. Minimum 6 characters. Enter password with at least 6 characters
Password must contain at least 2 non-letter characters, 0..9 or Enter password with minimum 2 non-letter characters
Persistance Out Of Range press ok and save this user-setting once again
Please plug off and on probe and try again. Plug it on a different probe connector see error message, connect another probe
PowerSpecBuffer memory allocation failed. Action: restart the system restart the system
Probe () doesn't contain correct ProbeVersion! Action: Please contact online center Please contact technical support
Probe with Probe-ID xx not supported. On Attempt to read Probe-ID from an invalid
Connect another probe
probe connector. Action: restart system
Probe with Probe-ID xx not supported on left probe connector (A). Connect another probe
Probe with Probe-ID xx not supported on middle probe connector (B). Connect another probe
Probe with Probe-ID xx not supported on right probe connector (C). Connect another probe
PW_BaseLinePos Out Of Range press ok and save this user-setting once again
PW_BurstCalcBlock: UserProgApplication out of range. Action: restart system restart the system
PW_CW_FFT_FactBlock: DSC_ScrollX_Zoom darf nicht kleiner als eins sein! restart the system
PW_Dynamic Out Of Range press ok and save this user-setting once again
PW_Reject Out Of Range press ok and save this user-setting once again
PWGain Out Of Range press ok and save this user-setting once again
PWM-Acoustic value not defined. Action: Please call technical support Please call technical support
Regional settings for Numbers/Decimal symbol has been changed back to '.' No action required (for information only)
RepresentationManager::vCreate: Nr. Dim 0 incorrect, see vSetReplayParams() call restart the system
RepresentationManager::vCreate: Nr. Dim 1 incorrect, see vSetReplayParams() call restart the system
RepresentationManager::vCreate: Nr. Dim 2 incorrect, see vSetReplayParams() call restart the system
RiseSmooth Out Of Range press ok and save this user-setting once again
RT_4DTissueFilterBlock::DMA Block size and calculated frame size differs!! restart the system
RT_PWorCWFilterBlock::RT_PWorCWFilterBlock():: iPWCW_InitializeProcessing
returned error code xx!! restart the system
Action: restart the system, If after restart not ok then call technical support\
RT_RFProcessingBlockColor::vCheckIQDataSizeAndUpdateTables: Memory
allocation failed. restart the system
Action: restart the system, If after restart not ok then call technical support
RT_RFProcessingBlockColor::vCheckRFDataSizeAndUpdateBuffers: Memory
allocation failed. restart the system
Action: restart the system, If after restart not ok then call technical support
RT_RFProcessingBlockTissue::vCheckRFDataSizeAndUpdateBuffers: Memory
allocation failed. restart the system
Action: restart the system, If after restart not ok then call technical support
RT-TissueFilter DLL call failed. Action: restart system restart the system
see <InfoValid> with disconnected ECG, xx of xx cycles OK (Test output, no error message)
Stop device failed. It is probably still in use, please try to stop it later. check if there is still a file open from the volume and retry
StoragePool: Not sufficient replay storage for B & CF Mode available restart the system
StoragePool: Not sufficient replay storage for ECG available restart the system
StoragePool: Not sufficient replay storage for M Mode available restart the system
StoragePool: Not sufficient replay storage for MC or PW Mode available restart the system
System must be restarted. Reason: Corrupt Factory Settings restart the system
The "Current Password" does not match the actual password. enter correct password
The "New Password" does not match with "Retype new password". retype both passwords
The Database UserPrograms Corrupted. Action: Restart the system restart the system
The Date format not stored properly. Action: close registry, restart, try again close registry, restart the system and try again
The device can now be safely removed from the system. press ok and remove the USB volume
The entered password does not match the actual password. enter correct password
The Handle Unregistered. Action: close registry, restart, try again close registry, restart the system and try again
The Registry not closed. Action: close registry, restart, try again restart the system
if possible,
• save “Full Backup” (see: Section 4-5-4 on page 4-43) to
The System detected a problem with your harddisk.
“DVD/CD”, “Network”, or “Other drive” (including images)
Please do not reboot or shut down the machine!
• if not currently done, save “Image Archive”
Please contact your service department as soon as possible.
(see: Section 4-5-7-1 on page 4-48),
• call technical support
Timeout, xx of xx cycles OK please call online center (OLC should contact R&D)
UI_BBC_ArchiveWnd::vSet() has an wrong ImageType. Action: restart the system restart the system
UI_Manager: failed to create BBC Wnd. Action: restart the system restart the system
Unable to complete export the TA!Unable to create new HDF5 file for TA! check free disk space
Unhandled Probe-EEPROM data type on left probe connector (A). Connect another probe
Unhandled Probe-EEPROM data type on middle probe connector (B). Connect another probe
Unhandled Probe-EEPROM data type on right probe connector (C). Connect another probe
Unhandled Probe-EEPROM data type on upper-left probe connector (CW). Connect another probe
Unknown Error Action: Load volume files from other storage medium. load volume files from other storage medium
Volume_dB Out Of Range press ok and save this user-setting once again
ViewerConMngr::vAssembleCF_DFE:attempt to get ECG_CalcHR-Block from restart the system(If after restart not ok then cal technical
ECGViewer Objects failed!! support)
Write error! Action: use a new CDR, call technical support use a new CDR
Write Protected cassette! Remove cassette from VCR and put writeable cassette Remove cassette from VCR and put writeable cassette
into drive of VCR. into drive of VCR
Write Protected DVD! Remove DVD and put writeable DVD into drive of Recorder. Put writeable DVD into Drive
Wrong disc type! Please enter a data disc and try again. enter data disc and try again
XTDTrackballCtrlState::No frame to trackball position found, internal failure!! restart the system
Chapter 8
Replacement Procedures
Section 8-1
Overview
8-1-1 Purpose of Chapter 8
This chapter contains replacement procedures for different modules and their subsystems.
NOTICE The Manpower, time and Tools indicated in the Sub-sections include all requirements from
!! NOTICE:
Preparations to Installation Procedures.
WARNING
WARNING No covers or panels should be removed from the system (high-voltage risk).
!! WARNING:
The Waste of Electrical and Electronic Equipment (WEEE) must not be disposed as unsorted
municipal waste and must be collected separately.
Please contact the manufacturer or other authorized disposal company for information
concerning the decommission of your equipment.
• system must be lowered to its minimum height with monitor flapped down (see: Figure on page 3-
13)
• the Control Console has to be centered and locked in “unextended” position
Equipment being returned must be clean and free of blood and other infectious substances.
GEHC policy states that body fluids must be properly removed from any part or equipment prior to
shipment. GEHC employees, as well as customers, are responsible for ensuring that parts/equipment
have been properly decontaminated prior to shipment. Under no circumstance should a part or
equipment with visible body fluids be taken or shipped from a clinic or site (for example, body coils or
and ultrasound probe).
The purpose of the regulation is to protect employees in the transportation industry, as well as the
people who will receive or open this package.
The US Department of Transportation (DOT) has ruled that “items what were saturated and/or dripping
with human blood that are now caked with dried blood; or which were used or intended for use in patient
care” are “regulated medical waste” for transportation purpose and must be transported as a hazardous
material.
Section 8-2
System Software - Installation/Upgrade Procedure
8-2-1 Introduction
NOTICE If the currently installed software has to be upgraded to a newer version, a new software specific
!! NOTICE:
“Permanent key is required. Please contact your local distributor or GE service representative.
1. Via the FMI from DVD button in the System Setup Service page.
• Software parts to be upgraded (e.g., Ultrasound Application Software, Service Software, EUM, MS
patches, etc.) and installation time depend on contents of the used System DVD.
• PRECONDITION: The first "Boot Device" in BIOS has to be Hard Disk Drive. To change BIOS Boot
Priority Order setting, see Section 5-16-5-4-1 "BIOS “Boot Priority Order” Setting" on page 5-69.
• If the currently installed software has to be upgraded to a newer version, a new software specific
"Permanent key" is required. (Calculated in OKOS - Option Key Order System) If you do not have
permission to access OKOS, contact the On Line Center to get the necessary key.
2. By downloading and installing a Software Update Package via active InSite connection.
• Software parts to be upgraded (e.g., Ultrasound Application Software, Service Software, EUM, MS
patches, etc.) and installation time depend on contents of the SW update package.
• PRECONDITION: InSite connection has to be configured and checked out. Operation see: Section
5-13-5 "Configuration" on page 5-54.
8-2-2 Manpower
One person ~ 1 hour (depends on contents of System DVD, peripherals, etc.)
8-2-3 Tools
System DVD
8-2-4 Preparations
Before performing the Software Upgrade:
NOTE: It is NOT necessary to save Full System Configuration (Full Backup) prior to the upgrade.
All existing User Programs, 3D/4D Programs and Auto Text settings remain untouched!
Receiver Use the FREQUENCY control to switch the Receiver Frequency no disturbances in the 2D image during
Frequency range (penet./norm/resol.). changing the Receiver Frequency
Start the “Abdomen” -Program and switch on the CFM- and the
Triplex no disturbances in the 2D/Color and
PW Mode. Adjust the Doppler Cursor and press the right trackball
Mode the Doppler image
key to activate the Triplex-Mode.
Voluson S8
Figure 8-1 Version check (System Setup - Administration - SYSTEM INFO page)
Voluson S8
D = Demo
(Option is activated for demo and expires
on the date shown in the “Valid” column)
I = Inactive
(Option is not activated)
P = Permanent
(Option is permanently activated [purchased]) Permanent Key
Voluson S6
D = Demo
(Option is activated for demo and expires
on the date shown in the “Valid” column)
I = Inactive
(Option is not activated)
P = Permanent
(Option is permanently activated [purchased])
Permanent Key
NOTICE Please print out the OPTIONS page or write down the “Permanent Key”.
!! NOTICE:
If the currently installed software has to be upgraded to a newer version, a new software specific
“Permanent key is required.
Please contact your local distributor or GE service representative.
Existing User Programs, 3D/4D Programs and Auto Text remain unaffected! Afterwards the new
software is configured such that it is integrated again in its environment.
CAUTION Disconnecting ALL external USB devices (except DVD/CD+R/RW drive) is NECESSARY.
!! CAUTION:
Re-installation of any previously attached printer has to be done after the upgrade procedure.
Note: Installing the Bluetooth Printer and its connection set is not possible by the user.
NOTE: For more detailed information about “FMI from DVD” refer to 5-14-3-2-1 on page 5-57.
NOTICE If the system boots into LINUX, the “Boot priority order” in BIOS is incorrect.
!! NOTICE:
In this case, cancel the software installation procedure (select Exit/Reboot by means of the [Arrow] keys
(right, left, up, down) and the [Enter] key on the keyboard) and then contact your service representative.
5.) After system restart, press the UTILITIES key on the control panel.
6.) In the “Utilities” menu select SYSTEM SETUP to invoke the setup desktop on the screen.
7.) On the left side of the screen select ADMINISTRATION and then click the SERVICE tab.
8.) Type in the password SHE and click ACCEPT.
9.) Click the FMI FROM DVD button (see: Figure 8-3 on page 8-8) for updating the System Software.
10.)Verify that only the DVD drive is connected to the system, then click OK (Figure 8-4 below).
Figure 8-4 Verify that USB devices are disconnected, then click OK
The system saves Full Backup in silent mode on R:, then it reboots into LINUX.
A silent “Rollback” image from C:\ is stored on R:\.
After executing all LINUX commands, the system reboots again.
NOTE: If the currently installed software has to be upgraded to a newer version, a new software specific
“Permanent key is required.
• Enter the appropriate “Permanent Key” (calculated in OKOS), select OK and confirm with ENTER.
• If the entered Permanent key is correct, following window appears, confirm with ENTER.
13.)3 dots (one after the other) appear on the screen (see: Figure 8-9 below).
3 dots
16.)Please wait until all processes are finished (100 percent completed).
17.)The system is rebooting into windows (Boot screen - Voluson).
18.)Please wait until all processes are finished. Finally the 2D screen is displayed on the monitor.
NOTE: If the BT warning dialog (Figure 8-13 below) appears, enter the proper “Permanent key” and then click
SUBMIT.
NOTICE After turning off a system, wait at least 10 seconds before turning it on again.
!! NOTICE:
The system may not be able to boot if power is recycled too quickly.
21.)Reconnect the external devices, install all the printers and adjust the printer settings as described
in Section 3-7 "Printer Installation" on page 3-32.
22.)Check and match Printer Remote Control selection in the System Setup - Connectivity - BUTTON
CONFIGURATION page.
23.)Confirm that the date and time are set correctly and that the Windows automatic DST feature is ON.
24.)Perform Software and Functional checks as described in Section 8-3 on page 8-20.
8-2-6-1 Overview
This icon (at the right bottom of the screen) indicates that a new Software
Update Package is available for download and installation.
The system software installation procedure starts with saving and recording the settings present on the
system (silent "Full Backup" and "Rollback"). Then the new software is written to the hard disk.
Application Settings are automatically updated, to match with new Software version.
Existing User Programs, 3D/4D Programs and Auto Text remain unaffected! Afterwards the new
software is configured such that it is integrated again in its environment.
5.) Download takes some time; please wait. (Download maybe paused by means of the Pause button.)
NOTE: Installation may take up to one hour. DO NOT interrupt the installation! If you want to install the new
software later, click Exit. Installation can be resumed by clicking Install (in the Shutdown window).
A silent "Rollback" image from C:\ is stored on R:\. After executing all LINUX commands, the system
reboots again.
10.)Booting auto.
11.)Updating will take some time. First the image is saved to R:\ (Saving NTSF to image ....); then the
image is restored from R:\ (Restoring NTFS from image ....).
12.)Please wait until all processes are finished (100 percent completed).
NOTE: An automated process was developed to install the required software parts, perform check disk, remap
drive letters and match settings. During this process the system might reboot several times!
15.)Reconnect the external devices, install all the printers and adjust the printer settings as described
in Section 3-7 "Printer Installation" on page 3-32.
16.)Check and match Printer Remote Control selection in the System Setup - Connectivity - Button
Configuration page.
17.)Confirm date and time setting in the System Setup - General - General page.
18.)Perform a check of all modes and features listed. (Move the cursor over the feature name to get
information how to check.)
19.)When all features are OK, enter your signature and then click Send. See Figure 8-20 above.
NOTE: If one feature gets "Failed", rollback the installation (restore the previously used system configuration).
For more detailed information, see Section 5-15-1-3 "Rollback" on page 5-60.
Section 8-3
Software and Functional Checks after Installation/Upgrade Procedure
1.) Press the UTILITIES key on the control panel.
2.) In the “Utilities” menu select SYSTEM SETUP to invoke the setup desktop on the screen.
3.) On the left side of the screen select ADMINISTRATION and then click the OPTION tab.
4.) Verify the correct settings of the OPTIONS page; see: Figure 8-2 on page 8-7.
If necessary, customize the settings according to the printout.
5.) Click the SYSTEM INFO tab.
Voluson S8
Application Software
version
Tune version
of Application presets
NOTICE It is neither required nor advisable to reload a previously stored “Full Backup” after a software
!! NOTICE:
upgrade that was performed by means of the FMI FROM DVD button!
If the Tune version does not match the Application Software version, a warning message appears
whenever booting up the system.
In this case, it is essential to load the proper Application Settings (image presets), adapted for the
installed software version. Refer to: 5-14-3-10 "Load Application Settings" on page 5-58.
8.) Connect at least one probe and then click the button at the bottom of the SYSTEM INFO page to start
Hardware configuration detection (see: Figure 8-21 above).
9.) Perform basic functional checks to ensure system is functioning normally. See Table 8-2 on page 8-
5.
8-20 Section 8-3 - Software and Functional Checks after Installation/Upgrade Procedure
GE DRAFT VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 DRAFT (DECEMBER 12, 2017) BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
Section 8-4
Image Settings Only - Loading Procedure
8-4-1 Introduction
The Image Settings contain:
• Application Settings
• User Programs
• Auto Text
• 3D/4D Programs
• Scan Assistant
• Measure configuration
Section 8-5
Full Backup (Full System Configuration) - Loading Procedure
8-5-1 Introduction
The Full Backup contains following data:
• User Settings (databases and files containing User Programs, 2D/3D/4D Programs, Auto Text
entries, gray curves and complete System settings such as language, time/date format, etc.)
• Measure Configuration (user specific measure setup settings)
• Patient Archive (database containing patient demographic data and measurements) - no images
• Options (Permanent Key that is specific for enabled software options and Demo Key)
• Image Transfer Configuration (DICOM settings e.g., DICOM servers, AE Title, Station Name, etc.)
• Network Configuration (network settings including the computer name)
• Service Platform (state of the Service Software)
Section 8-6
Image Archive - Loading Procedure
8-6-1 Introduction
A backup of the Image Archive contains the Patient Archive (database containing patient demographic
data and measurements) + images.
Section 8-7
Replacement or Activation of Options
3D Option b) Option c)
NOTE: After activating a key code, restart (turn off and on) the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 system.
Section 8-8
Replacement of Monitor
8-8-1 Manpower
2 people, 10 minutes
8-8-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver, Allen Wrench
2.) Unscrew 2 screws to remove the MONITOR CABLE HOLDER BRACKET. Refer to the figure
below.
MONITOR CABLE
HOLDER BRACKET
3.) Unscrew the MAIN PANEL LONG CABLE screw, then pull out the MAIN PANEL LONG CABLE
from the MONITOR CONNECTOR. Refer to the figure below.
4.) One person grab the MONITOR not to drop down the monitor and the other person unscrew 2
hexagonal socket screws, then separate the MONITOR from the MONITOR STAND ARM. Refer
to the figure below.
WARNING The monitor arm can spring up and cause serious damage or personal injury while separating the
WARNING
monitor. Hold the monitor arm while separating the monitor.
Section 8-9
Replacement of the MONITOR STAND ARM
8-9-1 Manpower
2 people, 20 minutes
8-9-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver, Nipper, Allen Wrench
3.) Remove the 2ND AXIS COVER. Refer to the figure below.
4.) Unhook the 2 hooks of 2ND ARM COVER and remove the 2ND ARM COVER. Refer to the figure
below.
6.) Unscrew 1 screw located in the bottom of the MONITOR STAND ARM and remove the 1ST ARM
COVER. Refer to the figure below.
8.) Extract the MAIN PANEL LONG CABLE through the hole. Refer to the figure below.
9.) Unscrew 1 screw to remove the MONITOR STAND ARM from OPIO.
10.)Pull out the MONITOR STAND ARM and extract the MAIN PANEL LONG CABLE through the hole.
Refer to the figure below.
Section 8-10
Replacement of OPIO
8-10-1 Manpower
One person, 15 minutes
8-10-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver, Nipper, Allen Wrench
8-10-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
3.) Unscrew 2 screws, then remove the OPIO COVER L, R. Refer to the figure below.
OP COVER L,R
Figure 8-37 Removing the OPIO COVER L,R
4.) Unscrew 9 screws located in the bottom of the OPIO and lift up the MAIN OPIO. Refer to the figure
below.
5.) Lift up the MAIN OPIO and disconnect 3 cables from the OPIO HUB PWA. Refer to the figure below.
OP PANEL CABLE
6.) Unscrew 4 screws to separate SUB OPIO and separate the SUB OPIO. Refer to the figure below.
Section 8-11
Replacement of the SPEAKER
8-11-1 Manpower
One person, 30 minutes
8-11-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver
8-11-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
Section 8-12
Replacement of the HARNESS CABLE
8-12-1 Manpower
One person, 20 minutes
8-12-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver, Nipper, Allen Wrench
8-12-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
6.) Pull out the MAIN PANEL LONG CABLE through the hole. Refer to the figure below.
7.) Unscrew 4 screws to detach the 3 cables from the OPIO. Refer to the figure below.
8.) Unscrew 1 screw located on the ELEVATION F-BLOCK BOTTOM COVER and remove the part.
Refer to the figure below.
ELECVATION F-BLOCK
BOTTOM COVER
9.) Remove the ELEVATION CABLE DUCT COVER. Refer to the figure below.
ELEVATION CABLE
BOTTOM COVER
10.)Unscrew 2 hexagonal socket screws to Remove 2 CABLE CLAMPS. Refer to the figure below.
CABLE CLAMP
11.)Pull out the 3 CABLES through the hole. Refer to the figure below.
12.)Pull out the 3 CABLES through the hole. Refer to the figure below.
13.)Unscrew 2 screws of POWER CORD FIX BRACKET. Then disconnect POWER CORD. Refer to
the figure below.
14.)Unscrew 5 screws to remove the REAR COVER ASSY. Refer to the figure below.
15.)Unscrew 4 screws to remove the SPEAKER DUMMY BACK COVER. Refer to the figure below.
Figure 8-53 Unscrewing 4 screws and remove the SPEAKER DUMMY BACK COVER
16.)Unscrew 3 screws to remove the CABLE COVER BRACKET. Refer to the figure below.
Figure 8-54 Unscrewing 3 screws and remove the CABLE COVER BRACKET
17.)Untie the CABLE CLAMP with finger. Refer to the figure below.
18.)Unscrew 2 screws to remove the MONITOR CABLE BRACKET. Then unscrew the screw of MAIN
PANEL LONG CABLE and disconnect the CABLE. Refer to the figure below.
Figure 8-56 Unscrewing 2 screws and remove the MONITOR CABLE BRACKET
19.)Disconnect other 2 cables. (OPIO PANEL CABLE, VS SPEAKER CABLE ASSY). Refer to the
figure below.
Section 8-13
Replacement of the NEST
8-13-1 Manpower
One person, 10 minutes
8-13-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver, Allen Wrench
8-13-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
10 11
1
10 11
2 1
12
3
2
4
13 12
5 3
6 4
13
7 5
14
8 6
9
7 14
8
# Cables FRU
6 USB cable -
7 HDMI cable -
8 Network cable -
9 Audio cable -
11 VNavi cable -
3.) Set the 4 RS KNOBS to unlock position to separate from the SIDE COVER R. and unscrew one
screw from the each 4 RS KNOB. Refer to the figure below.
4.) Remove the FRONT COVER ASSY and unscrew 2 screws. Refer to the figure below.
Figure 8-61 Removing the FRONT COVER ASSY and unscrew 2 screws
Section 8-14
Replacement of the AIR FILTER
8-14-1 Manpower
One person, 1 minutes
8-14-2 Tools
None
8-14-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
2.) Pull out the AIR FILTER. Refer to the figure below.
Section 8-15
Replacement of the Probe Holder(KIT)
8-15-1 Manpower
One person, 1 minutes
8-15-2 Tools
None
Section 8-16
Replacement of SIDE COVER L ASSY
8-16-1 Manpower
One person, 5 minutes
8-16-2 Tools
Philips Screwdriver
8-16-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
2.) Pull out the FRONT COVER ASSY. Refer to the figure below.
3.) Unscrew 3 screws and remove the SIDE COVER L ASSY. Refer to the figure below.
Section 8-17
Replacement of SIDE COVER R ASSY
8-17-1 Manpower
One person, 5 minutes
8-17-2 Tools
Philips Screwdriver
8-17-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
2.) Pull out the FRONT COVER ASSY. Refer to the figure below.
3.) Unscrew one screw from the each 4 RS KNOB. Refer to the figure below.
4.) Unscrew 3 screws and remove the SIDE COVER R ASSY. Refer to the figure below.
Section 8-18
Replacement of the Trackball
8-18-1 Manpower
One person, 10 minutes
8-18-2 Tools
Philips Screwdriver
8-18-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
2.) Unscrew 9 screws located in the bottom of the OPIO and lift up the MAIN OPIO. Refer to the figure
below.
3.) Lift up the MAIN OPIO and disconnect 3 cables from the OPIO HUB PWA. Refer to the figure below.
OP PANEL CABLE
4.) Disconnect the TRACKBALL CABLE from the OPIO HUB PWA. Refer to the figure below.
5.) Unscrew 2 screws and then pull out the TRACKBALL from the MAIN OPIO. Refer to the figure
below.
Section 8-19
Replacement of Encoder set
8-19-1 Manpower
One person, 40 minutes
8-19-2 Tools
Philips screw driver, spanner
5.) Pull 10 encoder key caps out. Refer to the figure below.
6.) Unscrew 17 screws and lift up the main keyboard circuit board. Refer to the figure below.
Figure 8-84 Unscrewing 17 screws and lifting up the main keyboard circuit board
7.) By using spanner, unscrew the nut of encoder to be replaced. And replace the encoder. Refer to
the figure below.
Figure 8-85 Unscrewing the nut of encoder and replace the encoder
8.) Pull the encoder out from the main keyboard circuit board. Refer to the figure below.
Section 8-20
Replacement of OPIO Button Sets
8-20-1 Manpower
One person, 40 minutes
8-20-2 Tool
Philips screw driver
5.) Pull 10 encoder key caps out. Refer to the figure below.
6.) Unscrew 17 screws and lift up the main keyboard circuit board. Refer to the figure below.
Figure 8-92 Unscrewing 17 screws and lifting up the main keyboard circuit board
Section 8-21
Replacement of the Wheel Key ASSY
8-21-1 Manpower
One person, 10 minutes
8-21-2 Tools
Philips Screwdriver
8-21-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
3.) Unscrew 2 screws and pull out the WHEEL KEY ASSY. Refer to the figure below.
Figure 8-95 Unscrewing 2 screws and pull out the WHEEL KEY ASSY
Section 8-22
Replacement of the TGC BOARD
8-22-1 Manpower
One person, 10 minutes
8-22-2 Tools
Philips Screwdriver
8-22-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
4.) Unscrew 4 screws. then pull out the TGC BOARD. Refer to the figure below.
Figure 8-98 Unscrewing 4 screws and pulling out the TGC BOARD
Section 8-23
Replacement of AN KEYBOARD ASSY
8-23-1 Manpower
One person, 15 minutes
8-23-2 Tools
Philips Screwdriver
8-23-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
3.) Unscrew 6 screws. and pull out the AN KEYBOARD and OPIO HUB PWA ASSY. Refer to the figure
below.
Figure 8-100 Unscrewing 6 screws and pulling out the AN KEYBOARD and OPIO HUB PWA ASSY
4.) Disconnect the AN KEYBOARD CABLE and unscrew 6 screws to remove the OPIO HUB PWA
ASSY. Refer to the figure below.
AN KEYBOARD CABLE
Figure 8-101 Unscrewing 6 screws and pull out the remove the OPIO HUB PWA ASSY
5.) Remove the HUB PCB BRACKET from AN KEYBOARD ASSY. Refer to the figure below.
Section 8-24
Replacement of the Caster Cap
8-24-1 Manpower
One person, 2 minutes
8-24-2 Tools
None
8-24-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
Section 8-25
Replacement of the CASTER
8-25-1 Manpower
One person, 10 minutes
8-25-2 Tools
Monkey Wrench
8-25-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
2.) Unfasten the NUT. And pull out the CASTER. Refer to the figure below.
Section 8-26
Replacement of the Monitor Covers
8-26-1 Manpower
Two people, 20 minutes
8-26-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver, Allen Wrench
8-26-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
Figure 8-106 Unscrewing 6 screws and removing the LCD REAR COVER
2.) Detach the FOIL attached on the OSD BUTTON PWA. Refer to the figure below.
3.) Unscrew 11 screws to remove the LCD PANEL ASSY with BRACKET. Refer to the figure below.
Figure 8-108 Unscrewing 11 screws to remove LCD PANEL ASSY with BRACKET
4.) Unscrew 3 screws to remove OSD BUTTON and remove the LCD PANEL ASSY. Refer to the figure
below.
Section 8-27
Replacement of the Footrest Cover
8-27-1 Manpower
One person, 2 minutes
8-27-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver
8-27-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
Section 8-28
Replacement of the SIDE TRAY
8-28-1 Manpower
One person, 2 minutes
8-28-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver
8-28-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
Section 8-29
Replacement of the REAR HANDLE
8-29-1 Manpower
One person, 5 minutes
8-29-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver
8-29-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
2.) Unscrew 5 screws to remove the REAR COVER ASSY. Refer to the figure below.
3.) Unscrew 3 hexagonal Socket screws to remove the REAR HANDLE. Refer to the figure below.
Section 8-30
Replacement of the OP COVER L,R
8-30-1 Manpower
One person, 5 minutes
8-30-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver
8-30-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
2.) Unscrew 2 screws, then remove the OPIO COVER L, R from. Refer to the figure below.
OP COVER L,R
Figure 8-118 Removing the OPIO COVER L, R
Section 8-31
Replacement of the CPS2/CPS2 with Battery
8-31-1 Manpower
One person, 30 minutes
8-31-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver, Allen Wrench
8-31-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
2.) Remove the rear covers and disconnect cables as described in 8-13-4 "Removal Procedure" 1), 2)
and 6) on page 8-45, except for pulling out the NEST.
CPS2
Section 8-32
Replacement of the RFS/RFS-G
8-32-1 Manpower
One person, 30 minutes
8-32-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver, Allen Wrench
8-32-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
2.) Remove the rear covers and disconnect cables as described in 8-13-4 "Removal Procedure" 1), 2)
and 6) on page 8-45, except for pulling out the NEST.
• SNO of Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 (Alphanumeric serial number can be found on main label at
back of system)
• Hardware ID number (See SYSTEM INFO page or label of RFS/RFS-G)
1.) Gather System Serial number and Hardware ID
- Press the UTILITIES key on upper OPIO, select SYSTEM SETUP, select
ADMINISTRATION, click on SYSTEM INFO and write down the "Hardware ID" number.
NOTICE The Hardware ID can also be found on the label on the RFS/RFS-G.
!! NOTICE:
Hardware ID
RFS RFS-G
2.) Call the OLC to get the "Serial Key" and the "Permanent Key"
3.) Program the System Serial number and re-enter the Permanent Key
To program the System SNO, click the OPTIONS tab:
a.) Enter the "Serial key" (alphanumeric letters based on system serial number and RFS/RFS-G
Hardware ID) in the field "Serial Number" (e.g., AEE1193428AA6078123456SU7). Then press
ENTER. it takes about several seconds to get response.
b.) Enter the "Permanent Key" in the field Permanent key, click the SUBMIT button and afterwards
SAVE & EXIT.
Confirm the Message box "BT-key state has been changed." with YES. The system reboots.
NOTICE If the previous mentioned steps was done correctly, the system will show the correct SNO and the prior
!! NOTICE:
installed options are enabled in the OPTIONS page.
NOTICE DO NOT reboot the system before you have changed the serial number successfully!
!! NOTICE:
4.) Check System Serial number, System Type, Hardware ID and Software options
a.) Press the UTILITIES key on upper OPIO, select SYSTEM SETUP, select ADMINISTRATION
and then select the OPTION tab.
Section 8-33
Replacement of the SOM in RFS
8-33-1 Manpower
One person, 30 minutes
8-33-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver, Allen Wrench
8-33-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
2.) Remove the rear covers and disconnect cables as described in 8-13-4 "Removal Procedure" 1), 2)
and 6) on page 8-45, except for pulling out the NEST.
3.) Remove the RFS as described in 8-32-3 on page 8-87.
CAUTION When replacing with new SOM, push the SOM in both side of RFS ASSY as below.
!! CAUTION:
2.) When COM Express (5324556-3) is installed to RFS (GPN : 5364098), fix the FAN power cable to
the stud of SOM using cable Tie (2160955) as below.
When COM Express (5324556-3) is installed to the RFS which has GPN 5364098-2 or higher, connect
FAN power cable to the connector in RFS assy as below.
Figure 8-129 FAN power cable connection on the RFS, 5364098-2 or higher
Section 8-34
Replacement of the SOM in RFS-G
8-34-1 Manpower
One person, 30 minutes
8-34-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver, Allen Wrench
8-34-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
2.) Remove the rear covers and disconnect cables as described in 8-13-4 "Removal Procedure" 1), 2)
and 6) on page 8-45, except for pulling out the NEST.
3.) Remove the RFS-G as described in 8-32-3 on page 8-87.
CAUTION When replacing with new SOM, push the SOM in both side of RFS-G ASSY as below.
!! CAUTION:
CAUTION After SOM in RFS-G is replaced, system is automatically turned off once. After that, turn on the
system again.
This is a new specification of SOM in RFS-G. It is not malfunctioning.
Section 8-35
Replacement of the HDD in RFS
8-35-1 Manpower
One person, 30 minutes
8-35-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver, Allen Wrench
8-35-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
2.) Remove the rear covers and disconnect cables as described in 8-13-4 "Removal Procedure" 1), 2)
and 6) on page 8-45, except for pulling out the NEST.
3.) Remove the RFS as described in 8-32-3 on page 8-87.
Section 8-36
Replacement of the HDD in RFS-G
8-36-1 Manpower
One person, 30 minutes
8-36-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver, Allen Wrench
8-36-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
2.) Remove the rear covers and disconnect cables as described in 8-13-4 "Removal Procedure" 1), 2)
and 6) on page 8-45, except for pulling out the NEST.
3.) Remove the RFS-G as described in 8-32-4 on page 8-87.
Section 8-37
Replacement of the DVR in RFS
8-37-1 Manpower
One person, 30 minutes
8-37-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver, Allen Wrench
8-37-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
2.) Remove the rear cover as described in Section 8-29 on page 8-81, except for pulling out the NEST.
3.) Remove the RFS as described in 8-32-3 on page 8-87.
Section 8-38
Replacement of the DVR in RFS-G
8-38-1 Manpower
One person, 30 minutes
8-38-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver, Allen Wrench
8-38-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
2.) Remove the rear covers and disconnect cables as described in 8-13-4 "Removal Procedure" 1), 2)
and 6) on page 8-45, except for pulling out the NEST.
3.) Remove the RFS-G as described in 8-32-3 on page 8-87.
Section 8-39
Replacement of the BF64II/BF128II
8-39-1 Manpower
One person, 30 minutes
8-39-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver, Allen Wrench
8-39-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
2.) Remove the rear covers and disconnect cables as described in 8-13-4 "Removal Procedure" 1), 2)
and 6) on page 8-45, except for pulling out the NEST.
3.) Remove 4 RS Knobs.
BFII/PIRIII
Section 8-40
Replacement of the PIRIII
8-40-1 Manpower
One person, 30 minutes
8-40-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver, Allen Wrench, Hirose ejector
8-40-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
2.) Remove the rear covers and disconnect cables as described in 8-13-4 "Removal Procedure" 1), 2)
and 6) on page 8-45, except for pulling out the NEST.
3.) Remove 4 RS Knobs.
BFII/PIRIII
Section 8-41
Replacement of the CSI
8-41-1 Manpower
One person, 30 minutes
8-41-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver, Allen Wrench
8-41-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
2.) Unscrew 4 screws to remove CSI board and Separate the LED connector and FAN connector.
HDD Status
Network Status
Network Speed
Orange: Megabit
Section 8-42
Replacement of the CBP
8-42-1 Manpower
One person, 30 minutes
8-42-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver, Allen Wrench
8-42-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
2.) Remove the rear cover as described in Section 8-13 on page 8-45.
Section 8-43
Replacement of the DVD
8-43-1 Manpower
One person, 10 minutes
8-43-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver
8-43-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
Section 8-44
Replacement of the OPIO Hub PWA
8-44-1 Manpower
One person, 30 minutes
8-44-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver
8-44-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
2.) Remove the rear cover as described in Section 8-10 on page 8-31.
Section 8-45
Replacement of the OPIO Sub PWA
8-45-1 Manpower
One person, 30 minutes
8-45-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver
8-45-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
2.) Remove the rear cover as described in Section 8-10 on page 8-31.
3.) Pull two cables from Sub Keyboard ASSY and unscrew 5 screws to remove two brackets and small
usb.
Section 8-46
Replacement of AN KEY TOP
8-46-1 Manpower
One person, 30 minutes
8-46-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver.
8-46-3 Preparations
Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
Figure 8-159 Remove key : '1', 'Left Shift', 'F5', '6', '7', 'H', 'J', 'N', 'Back space', 'Right Shift', 'Pg Up
2.) Loosen the 6 screws using the plus(+) screwdriver. Refer to below Figure 8-160.
3.) Pull out AN Key Top Assy from Keyboard Frame. Refer to below Figure 8-161.
4.) Replace old AN Key Top ASSY with the New AN Key Top ASSY.
5.) Push the 8 points to make AN key Top Assy strongly attach to Key frame. Refer to below Figure 8-
162.
6.) Remove '1' Key, 'Left Shift' Key, 'F5' Key, '6' Key, '7' Key, 'H' Key, 'J' Key, 'N' Key, 'Back space' Key,
'Right Shift' Key and 'Pg Up' Key by using fingertips. Refer to procedure '2)'
7.) Tighten the 6 screws using the plus(+) screwdriver. Refer to below Figure 8-163.
8.) Insert '1' Key, 'Left Shift' Key, 'F5' Key, '6' Key, '7' Key, 'H' Key, 'J' Key, 'N' Key, 'Back space' Key,
'Right Shift' Key and 'Pg Up' Key.
3.) Check that pressed key is displayed in the keyboard screen or log window except 'Fn' key when AN
Keyboard is pressed.
2.) If two screws exist, tighten 2 screws. And then, put “1” and “Enter” keys.
Section 8-47
Replacement of FULL AN KEY
8-47-1 Manpower
One person, 30 minutes
8-47-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver
2.) Lift up the OPIO Assy. And then, disconnect 3 cables from OPIO ASSY.
Section 8-48
Replacement of the Caps for Hardkeys
NOTICE Please observe that replacement procedure depend on key caps that have to be replaced!
• if just the circle key caps have to be replaced.
• if trackball buttons or mode key slices have to be replaced too, please contact your local distributor
or GE service representative.
8-48-1-1 Manpower
One person, approx. 1 minute/cap
8-48-1-2 Tools
Small-sized slotted screwdriver or tweezers.
Section 8-49
Replacing optional Peripherals
NOTICE Normally auxiliary devices and peripherals come pre-installed with the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6
!! NOTICE:
system.
8-49-1 Manpower
One person, 70 minutes
8-49-2 Tools
Standard Field Service Tool Kit
NOTICE READ and UNDERSTAND these instructions thoroughly before proceeding with the installation.
!! NOTICE:
Perform each step in sequence and check it off when completed. If a problem occurs after completion,
go back through the procedure and check for implementation errors before contacting your Ultrasound
Region.
CAUTION Possible Operational damage. Failure to strictly follow ESD (Electrostatic Discharge)
!! CAUTION:
precautions during this installation may cause constant or intermittent operational
abnormalities. Strictly follow all precautions.
Figure 8-174 Moving forward MID CABINET ASSY following Slide Rail
Figure 8-175 Fix BW PRINTER to COLOR PRINTER BRKT POLARIS with 4 screws (2306562, FH M3X6)
BW PRINTER ASSY
Figure 8-177 Assemble BW PRINTER ASSY to MID FRAME ASSY with 4 screws (5178673, SCREW FH M4X6)
Figure 8-178 Unscrew 5 screws and remove REAR COVER POLARIS ASSY
2
Figure 8-179 Connect DVD CABLE
7.) Remove DUMMY COVER COLOR PRINTER from MID CABINET ASSY.
8.) Assemble DUMMY CASE MID BW POLARIS with MID CABINET ASSY.
Figure 8-182 Assemble DUMMY CASE MID BW POLARIS with MID CABINET ASSY
Figure 8-184 Moving forward HIGH CABINET ASSY following Slide Rail
BW BRKT POLARIS
Figure 8-185 Fix BW PRINTER to BW BRKT POLARIS with 4 screws (2306562, FH M3X6)
BW PRINTER ASSY
Figure 8-187 Assemble BW PRINTER ASSY to HIGH FRAME ASSY with 4 screws (2159625, W/SP M4X8)
5.) Remove REAR COVER POLARIS ASSY. Refer to Figure 8-178 on page 8-130.
6.) Connect DVD/BW and COLOR PRINTER CABLE.
a.) DVD CABLE - Figure 8-179 on page 8-130.
b.) BW PRINTER CABLE - Figure 8-180 on page 8-130
Figure 8-189 Fix COLOR PRINTER to COLOR PRINTER BRKT POLARIS with 6 screws (2306562, FH M3X6)
Figure 8-191 Assemble COLOR PRINTER ASSY to MID FRAME ASSY with 4 screws (5178673, FH M4X6)
5.) Remove REAR COVER POLARIS ASSY. Refer to Figure 8-178 on page 8-130.
2
Figure 8-192 Connect COLOR PRINTER CABLE
Figure 8-194 Fix COLOR PRINTER to COLOR PRINTER BRKT POLARIS with 6 screws (2306562, FH M3X6)
Figure 8-196 Assemble COLOR PRINTER ASSY to HIGH FRAME ASSY with 4 screws (5178673, FH M4X6)
5.) Remove REAR COVER POLARIS ASSY. Refer to Figure 8-178 on page 8-130.
6.) Connect DVD/BW and COLOR PRINTER CABLE.
a.) DVD CABLE - Figure 8-179 on page 8-130.
b.) BW PRINTER CABLE -Figure 8-180 on page 8-130
c.) COLOR PRINTER CABLE - Figure 8-192 on page 8-138
Figure 8-198 Moving forward MID CABINET ASSY following Slide Rail
1
2
Figure 8-209 Unscrew 5 screws and remove REAR COVER POLARIS ASSY
Figure 8-210 Unscrew 4 screws and remove SPEAKER DUMMY BACK COVER BRKT
Figure 8-211 Unscrew 5 screws and remove SPEAKER DUMMY BACK BRKT
13.)Remove CABLE COVER BRKT POLARIS (In case of USB cable needs to be changed).
14.) Place HIGH FRAME GROUND BRKT on BACKBONE (HIGH CABINET only).
15.)Place SPEAKER DUMMY BRKT over the HIGH FRAME GROUND BRKT on BACKBONE (HIGH
CABINET only).
Figure 8-215 Place SPEAKER DUMMY BRKT on the HIGH FRAME GROUND BRKT
Figure 8-216 Assemble HIGH FRAME GROUND BRKT with 5 screws (2159625, W/SP PH M4X8)
2
1
NO GEPN NAME W T L
1 60
EMC GASKET IT5-7-2-
2 5304318 7.0 2.0 150
1000-15
3 60
19.)PRINTER installation - Refer to Chapter 8-49-3 Printer Installation (BW and Color).
20.)DVD installation procedure is in reverse order of remove procedure -Refer to part 6.), 7.) of this
Section
8-150 Section 8-49 - Replacing optional Peripherals
GE DRAFT VOLUSON™S8 / VOLUSON™S6
DIRECTION 5589164, REVISION 4 DRAFT (DECEMBER 12, 2017) BASIC SERVICE MANUAL
21.)SIDE COVER ASSY (L/R) assemble procedure is in reverse order of remove procedure - Refer to
Part 3.),4.),5.) of this Section
22.)FRONT COVER ASSY assemble procedure is in reverse order of remove procedure - Refer to Part
2.) of this Section.
23.)Installation of ELEVATION ARM DOWN STOPPER for HIGH CABINET Option Configuration.
a.) Remove LOWER GROUND CABLE POLARIS.
UP
Figure 8-220 Unscrew and Remove ELEVATION ARM DOWN STOPPER MID MIZAR
MID
HIGH
Figure 8-221 Shape of ELEVATION ARM DOWN STOPPER High and Mid
HIGH MID
UP UP
Front Front
(Cabinet) (Cabinet)
Figure 8-222 Direction of ELEVATION ARM DOWN STOPPER High and Mid
UP
Figure 8-223 ELEVATION ARM DOWN STOPPER HIGH POLARIS with 2 Hexagonal screws (5405682, HSH M6x30)
Figure 8-224 Fix LOWER GROUND CABLE POLARIS with screw (2159625, W/SP PH M4x8)
24.)REAR COVER and BRKT Assembly procedure is in reverse order of remove procedure. - Refer to
Part 9.), 10.), 11.), 12.) and 13.) of this section.
Put in HIGH CABINET ASSY for using slide rail and then it is assembled with latch
Figure 8-226 Moving forward MID CABINET ASSY following Slide Rail
2.) Procedure of Removing COLOR PRINTER is in reverse order of installation procedure. Refer to 8-
49-3-3 on page 8-136.
3.) Place DRAWER ASSY on the MID FRAME ASSY.
DRAWER ASSY
Figure 8-227 Place DRAWER ASSY on the MID FRAME ASSY
Figure 8-228 Assemble DRAWER to MID FRAME ASSY with 4 screws (5178673, FH M4X6)
Figure 8-229 Place MID CABINET on MID FRAME and Moving toward BACKBONE
Figure 8-232 Assemble HORIZONTAL TV PROBE HOLDER with 3 screws (2306565, BH M4x16)
Figure 8-234 Assemble TV PROBE HOLDER BASE with 2 screws (2159634, BH M4x10)
2.) Place the TV PROBE HOLDER RUBBER on the PROBE HOLDER BASE.
Section 8-50
Replacement of FAN with Cable ASSY II
8-50-1 Manpower
One person, 30 minutes.
8-50-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver, Allen Wrench
8-50-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
2.) Remove the rear cover as described in Section 8-13 on page 8-45.
Figure 8-236
NOTE: In case of installing FAN with Cable ASSY (GPN:5363484), replace screws to SCREW PH M4X30
(GPN:5176333) in FRU.
2.) Perform: FRU8-50: Replacement of FAN with Cable ASSY II - Functional Tests
Section 8-51
Functional Checks after FRU replacement (Debrief Guidelines)
1.) Perform required Functional and/or Leakage Current tests based upon the FRU being replaced.
2.) Clarify the scripts to debrief a Service Dispatch using your pole's dispatch tool.
Use this script in the Service Comments when debriefing a Service Dispatch.
Proprietary Service Manual, DIRECTION 5589164, Revision 4, Section [fill in appropriate section].
Equipment passed all required tests and is ready for use.
Section 8-52
Replacement of CWD
8-52-1 Manpower
One person, 30 minutes.
8-52-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver, Hirose ejector
8-52-3 Preparations
Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
Power Cord
4.) Unscrew Monitor Cable fix screw with "-" Driver and Disconnect all cable connectors.
Keyboard Cable
Monitor Cable Fix Screw
7.) Unscrew 6 screws and replace BF128II without CWD(p/n:5338209-2)/BF64II without CWD(p/
n:5396937-2) Board to BF128II with CWD(p/n:5433961)/BF64II with CWD(p/n:5433965) Boards
which have CWD Circuits.
Unscrew 6 screws
Section 8-53
Replacement of DCWD
8-53-1 Manpower
One person, 30 minutes.
8-53-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver, Hirose ejector
8-53-3 Preparations
Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
2.) Match screw point between DCWD Assy and PIRIII assy.
4.) Put the board assy into the system and Install in the reverse order of removal procedure.
5.) Perform: FRU8-53: Replacement of DCWD - Functional Tests
Section 8-54
Replacement of ECG Kit assy
8-54-1 Manpower
One person, 10 minutes.
8-54-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver
8-54-3 Preparations
Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
2.) Screw 2 screws of each point to assemble ECG Module to MIZAR FRAME.
Section 8-55
Replacement of UVC
Replace FRU part as described in system’s UVC Kit Installation Instruction (5452854) in CDL.
Section 8-56
Replacement of Battery Pack Assy
8-56-1 Manpower
One person, 20 minutes
8-56-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver
8-56-3 Preparations
Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
Figure 8-238 Disassemble Battery power and signal cables from CPS2 with Battery board
4.) Open cover and replace Battery pack from CPS2 with Battery top cover.
Figure 8-239 Replace Battery pack from CPS2 with Battery top cover
Section 8-57
Replacement of the GPU in RFS-G
8-57-1 Manpower
One person, 30 minutes
8-57-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver, Allen Wrench
8-57-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
2.) Remove the rear covers and disconnect cables as described in 8-13-4 "Removal Procedure" 1), 2)
and 6) on page 8-45, except for pulling out the NEST.
2.) After unscrew 2 point and pull out FAN connector, take out GPU module.
Section 8-58
Replacement of Battery
8-58-1 Manpower
One person, 30 minutes
8-58-2 Tools
Philips screwdriver, Allen Wrench
8-58-3 Preparations
1.) Power Off/Shutdown the system as described in 4-3-2 on page 4-4.
2.) Remove the rear covers and disconnect cables as described in 8-13-4 "Removal Procedure" 1), 2)
and 6) on page 8-45, except for pulling out the NEST.
2.) Unscrew 14 screws of CPS2. Then separate CPS2_BOX_BRKT_2. Refer to the figure below.
3.) Install BOB Assy(Using SCREW WH M3X6), BATTERY PACK and BATTERY_CAP_BRKT (Using
SCREW PH W/SP M4X8). Refer to the figure below.
4.) Connect CPS2 BATTERY POWER CABLE and CPS2 BATTERY SIGNAL CABLE. Attach Read
Manual Label near BOB Assy. Refer to the figure below.
5.) Install CPS FAN Assy using SCREW PH M3X25. Refer to the figure below.
6.) Connect CPS2 BATTERY POWER and SIGNAL CABLE on CPS_DCDC2_4D Assy. Refer to the
figure below.
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up
Proprietary Service Manual,
8-3 Software and Functional Checks after Installation/Upgrade Procedure DIRECTION 5589164,
Revision 4, Section 8-2.
Table 8-2 System Function
Equipment passed all required
4-3-2 tests and is ready for use.
Power Off / Shutdown
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up Proprietary Service Manual,
DIRECTION 5589164,
Table 8-2 System Function
Revision 4, Section 8-3.
4-3-2 Equipment passed all required
Power Off / Shutdown
tests and is ready for use.
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
Table 8-2 System Function Proprietary Service Manual,
DIRECTION 5589164,
Revision 4, Section 8-7.
functional checks depend on activated option
Equipment passed all required
tests and is ready for use
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up
Proprietary Service Manual,
6-3 LCD Monitor Adjustment DIRECTION 5589164,
Revision 4, Section 8-8.
Table 8-2 System Function
Equipment passed all required
4-3-2 tests and is ready for use.
Power Off / Shutdown
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up
Proprietary Service Manual,
7-11-1 Console Test DIRECTION 5589164,
Revision 4, Section 8-10
Table 8-2 System Function Equipment passed all required
tests and is ready for use.
4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up
Proprietary Service Manual,
Table 8-2 System Function DIRECTION 5589164,
Revision 4, Section 8-11
4-4-4 Spectral Doppler Mode Checks Equipment passed all required
tests and is ready for use.
4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up Proprietary Service Manual,
Table 8-2 DIRECTION 5589164,
System Function
Revision 4, Section 8-12
4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown Equipment passed all required
tests and is ready for use.
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up Proprietary Service Manual,
Table 8-2 DIRECTION 5589164,
System Function
Revision 4, Section 8-13
4-3-2 Equipment passed all required
Power Off / Shutdown
tests and is ready for use.
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up
Proprietary Service Manual,
7-11-1 Console Test DIRECTION 5589164,
Revision 4, Section 8-18
Table 8-2 System Function Equipment passed all required
tests and is ready for use.
4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up
Proprietary Service Manual,
7-11-1 Console Test DIRECTION 5589164,
Revision 4, Section 8-21
Table 8-2 System Function Equipment passed all required
4-3-2 tests and is ready for use.
Power Off / Shutdown
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up
Proprietary Service Manual,
7-11-1 Console Test DIRECTION 5589164,
Revision 4, Section 8-22
Table 8-2 System Function Equipment passed all required
tests and is ready for use.
4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up
Proprietary Service Manual,
7-11-1 Console Test DIRECTION 5589164,
Revision 4, Section 8-23
Table 8-2 System Function Equipment passed all required
tests and is ready for use.
4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up Proprietary Service Manual,
DIRECTION 5589164,
Revision 4, Section 8-26
4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown Equipment passed all required
tests and is ready for use.
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up Proprietary Service Manual,
DIRECTION 5589164,
Revision 4, Section 8-29
4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown Equipment passed all required
tests and is ready for use.
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up Proprietary Service Manual,
DIRECTION 5589164,
Table 8-2 System Function
Revision 4, Section 8-31
Equipment passed all required
4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown tests and is ready for use.
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up Proprietary Service Manual,
DIRECTION 5589164,
Table 8-2 System Function
Revision 4, Section 8-32
Equipment passed all required
4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown tests and is ready for use.
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up Proprietary Service Manual,
DIRECTION 5589164,
Table 8-2 System Function
Revision 4, Section 8-33
Equipment passed all required
4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown tests and is ready for use.
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up Proprietary Service Manual,
DIRECTION 5589164,
Table 8-2 System Function
Revision 4, Section 8-34
Equipment passed all required
4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown
tests and is ready for use.
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up Proprietary Service Manual,
DIRECTION 5589164,
Table 8-2 System Function
Revision 4, Section 8-35
Equipment passed all required
4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown
tests and is ready for use.
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up Proprietary Service Manual,
DIRECTION 5589164,
Table 8-2 System Function
Revision 4, Section 8-36
Equipment passed all required
4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown tests and is ready for use.
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up
Proprietary Service Manual,
Table 8-2 System Function DIRECTION 5589164,
Revision 4, Section 8-37
N/A functional checks depend on option Equipment passed all required
4-3-2 tests and is ready for use.
Power Off / Shutdown
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up
Proprietary Service Manual,
Table 8-2 System Function DIRECTION 5589164,
Revision 4, Section 8-38
N/A functional checks depend on option Equipment passed all required
4-3-2 tests and is ready for use.
Power Off / Shutdown
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up Proprietary Service Manual,
DIRECTION 5589164,
Table 8-2 System Function
Revision 4, Section 8-39
Equipment passed all required
4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown
tests and is ready for use.
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up Proprietary Service Manual,
DIRECTION 5589164,
Table 8-2 System Function
Revision 4, Section 8-40
Equipment passed all required
4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown tests and is ready for use.
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up Proprietary Service Manual,
DIRECTION 5589164,
Table 8-2 System Function
Revision 4, Section 8-41
Equipment passed all required
4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown tests and is ready for use.
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up Proprietary Service Manual,
DIRECTION 5589164,
Table 8-2 System Function
Revision 4, Section 8-42
Equipment passed all required
4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown
tests and is ready for use.
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up
Proprietary Service Manual,
Table 8-2 System Function DIRECTION 5589164,
Revision 4, Section 8-43
7-12-6 DVD/CD+R/RW Drive Test Equipment passed all required
tests and is ready for use.
4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up
Proprietary Service Manual,
7-11-1 Console Test DIRECTION 5589164,
Revision 4, Section 8-44
Table 8-2 System Function Equipment passed all required
4-3-2 tests and is ready for use.
Power Off / Shutdown
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up
Proprietary Service Manual,
7-11-1 Console Test DIRECTION 5589164,
Revision 4, Section 8-45
Table 8-2 System Function Equipment passed all required
tests and is ready for use.
4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up
Proprietary Service Manual,
7-11-1 Console Test DIRECTION 5589164,
Revision 4, Section 8-46
Table 8-2 System Function Equipment passed all required
tests and is ready for use.
4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up
Proprietary Service Manual,
7-11-1 Console Test DIRECTION 5589164,
Revision 4, Section 8-47
Table 8-2 System Function Equipment passed all required
tests and is ready for use.
4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
10-7-5 Enclosure Leakage Current Test Proprietary Service Manual,
DIRECTION 5589164,
Revision 4, Section 8-47
4-7 Peripheral Checks Equipment passed all required
tests and is ready for use.
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up Proprietary Service Manual,
Table 8-2 DIRECTION 5589164,
System Function
Revision 4, Section 8-50
4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown Equipment passed all required
tests and is ready for use.
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up
Proprietary Service Manual,
10-5-2 Functional Checks DIRECTION 5589164,
Revision 4, Section 8-52
4-4-4 Spectral Doppler Mode Checks Equipment passed all required
4-3-2 tests and is ready for use.
Power Off / Shutdown
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
10-7-5 Enclosure Leakage Current Test Proprietary Service Manual,
DIRECTION 5589164,
Revision 4, Section 8-53
4-7 Peripheral Checks Equipment passed all required
tests and is ready for use.
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
10-7-5 Enclosure Leakage Current Test Proprietary Service Manual,
DIRECTION 5589164,
Revision 4, Section 8-54
4-7 Peripheral Checks Equipment passed all required
tests and is ready for use.
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up Proprietary Service Manual,
DIRECTION 5589164,
Table 8-2 System Function
Revision 4, Section 8-57
Equipment passed all required
4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown
tests and is ready for use.
Functional and/or
See Section Leakage Current Test Debrief Script
4-3-1 Power On / Boot Up
Chapter 9
Renewal Parts
Section 9-1
Overview
9-1-1 Purpose of Chapter 9
This chapter gives an overview of replacement parts available for the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6.
Section 9-2
List of Abbreviations
AC Alternating Current
ADC Analog to Digital Converter
A/N Key Alpha Numeric Keys
ASIC Application Specific Integrated Circuit
Assy Assembly
BF64II 64ch Beamformer module
BF128II 128ch Beamformer module
CBP Backplane interface module
CPS* Common Power Supply
CPS2 Common Power Supply 2
CPS2 with battery Common Power Supply 2 with battery
CPU Central Processing Unit
CSI Common Status Indicator module
CWDM Continuous wave doppler module
DAC Digital to Analog Converter
DC Direct Current
DSP Digital Signal Processing
DVD Digital Video Disc
DVI Digital Visual Interface
ECGP Electrocardiography module
EUM Electronic User Manual
FRU 1 Replacement part available in parts hub
FRU 2 Replacement part available from the manufacturer (lead time
involved)
HDD Hard Disk Drive
Int Internal
I/O Input/Output
LCD Liquid Crystal Display
PCI Peripheral Component Interconnect
PWA Printed Wire Assembly
RFS Radio frequency module
RFS-G Radio frequency module with GPU for HDLive
SOM System On Module
USB Universal Serial Bus
CRU Customer replaceable unit
Section 9-3
Parts List Groups
201-203 LCD Table 9-4 on page 9-6 Monitor and its covers
301-330 OPIO Table 9-5 on page 9-8 User interface parts & speaker
601-606 Options Table 9-8 on page 9-15 Options and power cord
701-710 Optional Peripherals and Accessories Table 9-9 on page 9-17 Optional Equipment
System Manuals - Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 Table 9-10 on page 9-18 System Manuals
Probes
801-805 • 2D curved array Transducers Table 9-12 on page 9-19
Probes
811-813 • 2D linear array Transducers Table 9-13 on page 9-20
821-825 • Real-Time 4D Volume Probes Table 9-14 on page 9-21
Section 9-4
Plastics Covers (Front/Sides/Rear)
105
106
107
108
Figure 9-2 Plastics Covers (Front/Side/Rear)
Part
Item Part Name Number Description Qty FRU BT11 BT12 BT14 BT15
Side Cover R Plastics cover for right side (RS probe connector)’
101 5405168 1 1 Y Y Y Y
Assy for Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6
Section 9-5
LCD Monitor
201
202
203
Part
Item Part Name Number Description Qty FRU BT11 BT12 BT14 BT15
201 19inch LED 5653621-2 19inch LCD Monitor 1 1 Y Y Y Y
302 303
301
304 306
305
307
308 309
312
310
311
326 327
313 330
329
328 330
332
Part
Item Part Name Number Description Qty FRU BT11 BT12 BT14 BT15
OPIO PANEL
301 5370998-2 OPIO PANEL ASSY 1 1 Y Y Y Y
ASSY
New A/N Key Top, New A/n Key Top with Base
313 5480208 1 1 Y Y Y Y
English Assembly, English
New A/N Key Top, New A/n Key Top with Base
314 5480206 1 1 Y Y Y Y
Swedish Assembly, Swedish
Part
Item Part Name Number Description Qty FRU BT11 BT12 BT14 BT15
New A/N Key Top, New A/n Key Top with Base
315 5480207 1 1 Y Y Y Y
Norwegian Assembly, Norwegian
New A/N Key Top, New A/n Key Top with Base
316 5480203 1 1 Y Y Y Y
Finnish Assembly, Finnish
New A/N Key Top, New A/n Key Top with Base
317 5480204 1 1 Y Y Y Y
Danish Assembly, Danish
New A/N Key Top, New A/n Key Top with Base
318 5480196 1 1 Y Y Y Y
Portuguese Assembly, Portuguese
New A/N Key Top, New A/n Key Top with Base
319 5480199 1 1 Y Y Y Y
Spanish Assembly, Spanish
New A/N Key Top, New A/n Key Top with Base
320 5480200 1 1 Y Y Y Y
Italian Assembly, Italian
New A/N Key Top, New A/n Key Top with Base
321 5480201 1 1 Y Y Y Y
German Assembly, German
New A/N Key Top, New A/n Key Top with Base
322 5480202 1 1 Y Y Y Y
French Assembly, French
New A/N Key Top, New A/n Key Top with Base
323 5480209 1 1 Y Y Y Y
Russian Assembly, Russian
New A/N Key Top, New A/n Key Top with Base
324 5480210 1 1 Y Y Y Y
Greek Assembly, Greek
329 Upper Keyboard for 5437491-2 Upper Keyboard for VS8 Pro 1 1 Y Y Y Y
VS8 Pro
VOLUSON S6_S8
VOLUSON S6_S8 OPIO
332 OPIO RUBBER 5715002 1 1 Y Y Y Y
RUBBER SET
SET
402 403
401
406
404 405
408 409
423
424
411
414
412 413
418 419
427
426
Part
Item Part Name Number Description Qty FRU BT11 BT12 BT14 BT15
401 PIR III PWA assy 5366065-3 Probe interface Board Assy 1 1 Y Y Y Y
SOM w/ 2GB
408 5324556-3 CPU module (P8400) 1 1 Y Y Y Y
Memory, (P8400)
Isolation
411 Transformer Cover 5440562 For external monitor or peripheral 1 1 Y Y Y Y
Kit
CPS2 Assy
424 CPS2 Assy 6002001 CPS Assy (5393431-3) is alternative 1 1 Y Y Y Y
part.
Section 9-8
Mechanical Parts
505 506
504
508
507
513 514
Part
Item Part Name Number Description Qty FRU BT11 BT12 BT14 BT15
501 Total Lock Caster 5400391-2 Caster with the locking available 1 1 Y Y Y Y
601 603
603 604
605 606
Part
Item Part Name Number Description Qty FRU BT11 BT12 BT14 BT15
Vertical TV probe
601 5408092 Vertical TV probe holder 1 1 Y Y Y Y
holder
Horizontal TV
602 5408514 Horizontal TV probe holder 1 1 Y Y Y Y
probe holder
3 button footswitch
603 5380960-2 3 button Foot Switch 1 1 Y Y Y Y
Rev1.1
Section 9-10
Optional Peripherals and Accessories
9-10-1 Printers and options
708 709
705
706
711
712 710
713
715 714
716
Part
Item Part Name Number Description Qty FRU BT11 BT12 BT14 BT15
B&W Printer
Digital B&W Printer Digital
702 5599699 1 1 Y Y Y Y
(SONY, UP- (SONY, UP-D898)
D898)
707 ECG kit assy 5433498 consists of ECG Module and 2 screws 1 1 N Y N N
Universal Video
710 5589401-2 Universal Video Converter S200 1 1 N N Y Y
Converter S200
Universal Video
711 5750263 Universal Video Converter S300 1 1 N N Y Y
Converter S300
VS8_VS6_VP9_
VS8_VS6_VP9_
713 VP6 ECG 5669519 1 1 N N Y Y
VP6 ECG MODULE ASSY
MODULE ASSY
Section 9-11
System Manuals
Table 9-10 System Manuals - Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6
Part # Part #
Part Name
VS8 VS6
Service Manual H44762LF H44762LF
Section 9-12
Probes
Table 9-11 below outlines the replacement parts described in the sub-sections.
Table 9-11 Probes - Replacement Parts
NOTE: If a probe is only available for Voluson™ S8, it is marked by * (eg. ML6-15-RS*).
801 802
Part
Item Name Part Number Description Qty FRU BT11 BT12 BT14 BT15
Part
Item Name Part Number Description Qty FRU BT11 BT12 BT14 BT15
C1-5-RS
Broadband curved array transduce, 2.0 - 5.0 MHz,
(C1-5-
804 5384875 192 Elements, Applications: Abdominal, Obstetrics, - 1 Y Y Y Y
RS* on
Gynecology.
BT12)
Part Part
Item Name Number Description Qty FRU BT11 BT12 BT14 BT15
821
823,
821
822
824
825
Part Part
Item Name Number Description Qty FRU BT11 BT12 BT14 BT15
826
827
Part Part
Item Name Number Description Qty FRU BT11 BT12 BT14 BT15
828
Part Part
Item Name Number Description Qty FRU BT11 BT12 BT14 B15
Continuous Wave (CW) Doppler pencil probe with a cen-
ter frequency of 2.0 MHz (no B-image), 2 Elements Appli-
828 P2D TE100024 - 1 N Y Y Y
cations: Cardiology (suprasternal), Peripheral Vascular,
Neurology
Section 9-13
Power Cord
835 837
834
844
831 Power Cord for India 5182611 Power Cord for India 1 1 1
832 Power Cord for Switzerland 5182235 Power Cord for Switzerland 1 1 1
833 Power Cord for UK/HK 5182816 Power Cord for UK/HK 1 1 1
834 Power Cord for ANZ 5182296 Power Cord for ANZ 1 1 1
835 Power Cord for Denmark 5182083 Power Cord for Denmark 1 1 1
836 Power Cord for Italy 5182940 Power Cord for Italy 1 1 1
837 Power Cord for Argentina 5182942 Power Cord for Argentina 1 1 1
838 Power Cord for Israel 5182453 Power Cord for Israel 1 1 1
840 Power Cord 220V for EU 2327990 Power Cord 220V for EU 1 1 1
841 Power Cord for China 2388981 Power Cord for China 1 1 1
842 Power Cord for Brazil 5399665 Power Cord for Brazil 1 1 1
844 Power Cord for Japan 5408490 Power Cord for Japan 1 1 1
Section 9-14
Biopsy Needle Guides
855
851
852
856
853
854
857
E8C-RS Biopsy
disposable Biopsy needle guide for probe E8C-RS
851 guide E8385MJ - 1 N
needle diameter: < 1.65 mm
(disposable)
E8C-RS Biopsy
reusable Biopsy needle guide for probe E8C-RS
852 guide H40412LN - 1 N
needle diameter: < 1.65 mm
(reusable)
862
861
863
PEC78 (RAB Non Sterile Single Angle Bracket needle guide for probe RAB4-8-
862 Single-angle H46701AE RS, RAB2-5-RS - 1 N
bracket) needle diameter: > 0.6 mm - < 2.1 mm
Non Sterile Single Angle Bracket needle guide for probe RAB2-6-RS
RAB Single-angle
863 H48681ML and RAB6-RS - 1 N
bracket
needle diameter: > 0.6 mm - < 2.1 mm
871 872
874
873
875 876
C1-5-RS Non Sterile Multi Angle Bracket needle guide for probe C1-5-RS needle
871 H40432LE - 1 N
Biopsy guide diameter: > 0.6 mm - < 2.1 mm
12L-RS Multi- Non Sterile Multi Angle Bracket needle guide for probe 12L-RS
872 H40432LC - 1 N
angle bracket needle diameter: > 0.6 mm - < 2.1 mm
9L-RS Multi- Non Sterile Multi Angle Bracket needle guide for probe 9L-RS
873 H4906BK - 1 N
angle bracket needle diameter: > 0.6 mm - < 2.1 mm
ML6-15-RS Non Sterile Multi Angle Bracket needle guide for probe ML6-15-RS
874 H40432LJ - 1 N
Biopsy kit needle diameter: > 0.6 mm - < 2.1 mm
3Sc-RS Multi- Non Sterile Multi Angle Bracket needle guide for probe 3Sc-RS
875 H46222LC - 1 N
angle bracket needle diameter: > 0.6 mm - < 2.1 mm
4C-RS Multi- Non Sterile Multi Angle Bracket needle guide starter kit for probe 4C-RS
876 E8385NA - 1 N
angle bracket needle diameter: > 0.6 mm - < 2.1 mm
Chapter 10
Care & Maintenance
Section 10-1
Overview
10-1-1 Periodic Maintenance Inspections
It has been determined by engineering that your Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 system does not have any
high wear components that fail with use, therefore no Periodic Maintenance Inspections are mandatory.
However, some Customers Quality Assurance Programs may require additional tasks and/or
inspections at a different frequency than listed in this manual.
CAUTION Practice good ESD prevention. Wear an anti–static strap when handling electronic parts and
!! CAUTION:
even when disconnecting/connecting cables.
CAUTION DO NOT operate this unit unless all board covers and frame panels are securely in place, to
!! CAUTION:
ensure optimal system performance and cooling.
When covers are removed, EMI may be present.
Section 10-2
Why do Maintenance
10-2-1 Keeping Records
It is good business practice that ultrasound facilities maintain records of quality checks and corrective
maintenance. The Ultrasound Inspection Certificate (see: page 10-30) provides the customer with
documentation that the ultrasound scanner is maintained on a periodic basis.
A copy of the Ultrasound Inspection Certificate should be kept in the same room or near the scanner.
Routine quality control testing must occur regularly. The same tests are performed during each period
so that changes can be monitored over time and effective corrective action can be taken.
Testing results, corrective action and the effects of corrective action must be documented and
maintained on the site.
Your GE service representative can help you with establishing, performing and maintaining records for
a quality assurance program. Please contact us for coverage information and/or price for service.
Section 10-3
Maintenance Task Schedule
10-3-1 How often should care & maintenance tasks be performed?
The Customer Care Schedule (see: page 10-3) specifies how often your Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6
should be serviced and outlines items requiring special attention.
NOTE: It is the customer’s responsibility to ensure the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 care & maintenance is
performed as scheduled in order to retain its high level of safety, dependability and performance.
The service procedures and recommended intervals shown in the Customer Care Schedule assumes
that you use your Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 for an average patient load (10-12 per day) and not use
it as a primary mobile unit which is transported between diagnostic facilities.
NOTE: If conditions exist which exceed typical usage and patient load, then it is recommended to increase the
maintenance frequencies.
10-3-1 How often should care & maintenance tasks be performed? (cont’d)
Clean LCD Monitor surface and Probe Be careful not to get the cloth
LCD Monitor and Probe
holder
holder with a fluid detergent in warm water • too wet so that moisture does
on a soft, damp cloth. not enter the entire system.
Control Console
movement
Check Translation/Rotation and Height
Adjustment (Elevation)
• more frequently at Mobile Units
Trackball Check
Check proper operation
(Cursor movement X, Y direction)
• If failure occurs go to trackball
cleaning.
Probe connectors
Remove dust/dirt of all probe connectors.
Clean with vacuum cleaner if dust is visible.
•
Also after corrective
Console Leakage
Current Checks
• maintenance or as required by
your facilities QA program.
Section 10-4
Tools Required
46–194427P231 Kit includes anti–static mat, wrist strap and cables for 200 to 240
46–194427P279 V system
Anti Static Kit 46–194427P369 3M #2204 Large adjustable wrist strap
46–194427P373 3M #2214 Small adjustable wrist strap
46–194427P370 3M #3051 conductive ground cord
46–194427P278 120V
Anti Static Vacuum Cleaner
46–194427P279 230V
Safety Analyzer 46–285652G1 DALE 600 KIT (or equivalent) for electrical tests
B/W Printer Cleaning Sheet see printer user manual for requirements
Color Printer Cleaning Sheet see printer user manual for requirements
Disposable Gloves
Screwdriver PH0
Screwdriver PH1
Screwdriver PH2
Section 10-5
System Maintenance
10-5-1 Preliminary Checks
The preliminary checks take about 15 minutes to perform. Refer to the system user documentation
whenever necessary.
Fill in the top of the Ultrasound Inspection Certificate (see: page 10-30).
2 Paperwork
Note all probes and system options.
3 Power up Turn the system power on and verify that all fans and peripherals turn on.
Watch the displays during power up to verify that no warning or error messages are displayed.
“Full Backup” all customer presets on Hard disk and/or DVD (see: Section 4-5-4 "Save Full System
6 Presets
Configuration (Full Backup)" on page 4-43).
Backup the Image Archive on DVD, USB-Stick, etc. (see: Section 4-5-7-1 "Save Image Archive" on
7 Image Archive
page 4-48).
9 Keyboard Test Perform the Keyboard Test Procedure to verify that all keyboard controls are OK.
Scan a gray scale phantom(optional) and use the measurement controls to verify distance
11 Measurements and area calculation accuracy.
Refer to the Basic User Manual, for measurement accuracy specifications.
NOTE: * Some software may be considered standard depending upon system configuration.
2 Color Printer Verify hardcopy output of the Color video page printer. Clean heads and covers if necessary.
Color Deskjet
3 Verify hardcopy output of the Deskjet (Bluetooth) printer. Clean heads and covers if necessary.
(Bluetooth) Printer
5 DVD Recorder Verify record capabilities of the DVD Recorder. Clean heads and covers if necessary.
6 DICOM Verify that DICOM is functioning properly. Send an image to a DICOM device.
Verify that the LINE, NEUTRAL and GROUND wires are properly attached to the terminals, and that
3 Terminals
no strands may cause a short circuit.
10-5-4 Cleaning
Use a fluid detergent in warm water on a soft, damp cloth to carefully wipe the entire system.
1 Console Be careful not to get the cloth too wet so that moisture does not enter the console.
Caution: DO NOT allow any liquid to drip or seep into the system.
Clean LCD Monitor surface with a fluid detergent in warm water on a soft, damp cloth.
2 LCD Monitor Caution: DO NOT spray any liquid directly onto the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 covers, LCD Monitor,
keyboard, etc.
2 Scratches & Dents Inspect the console for dents, scratches or cracks.
3 Inspect the LCD Monitor Display for scratches and raster burns.
LCD Monitor Display
Verify proper operation of Contrast and Brightness controls.
Inspect the Control Panel and Keyboard. Note any damaged or missing items.
4 Control Panel and (Replace faulty components, as required).
Keyboard
Verify proper operation of Control Panel backlighting and TGC sliders.
Clean the drive head and media with the vendor-supplied cleaning kit.Advise the user to repeat
5 DVD+R/RW Drive this often, to prevent future problems. DVDs/CDs must be stored away from dust and cigarette
smoke. Do not use alcohol or benzene to clean the drive
Check all wheels and casters for wear and verify operation of foot brake, to stop the unit from
6 Wheels & Brakes
moving, and release mechanism. Check all wheel locks and swivel locks for proper operation.
7 Check all internal cable harnesses and connectors for wear and secure connector seating.
Cables & Connectors
Pay special attention to footswitch assembly and probe strain or bend reliefs.
Check the power cord for cuts, loose hardware, tire marks, exposed insulation or other
8 Power Cord deterioration, and verify continuity. Tighten the clamps that secure the power cord to the unit and
the outlet plug to the cord.
9 Check to ensure that all EMI shielding, internal covers, air flow panels and screws are in place.
Shielding & Covers
Missing covers and hardware could cause EMI/RFI problems during scanning.
11 External I/O Check all connectors for damage and verify that the labeling is good.
12 Op Panel Lights Check proper operation of all control panel key illuminations (flash once during system start-up).
1 Probes Thoroughly check the system probe connectors and remove dust from inside the connector
sockets if necessary. Visually check for bent, damaged or missing pins.
2 Probe Holder Clean probe holders (they may need to be soaked to remove excess gel).
Ultrasound probes can be easily damaged by improper handling. Review the Basic User Manual of
Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 for more details. Failure to follow these precautions can result in serious
injury and equipment damage. Failure to properly handle or maintain a probe may also void its warranty.
OK OK OK
Do a visual check of the probe pins and system sockets before plugging in a probe.
CAUTION Failure to follow the prescribed cleaning or disinfection procedures will void the probe’s
!! CAUTION:
warranty. DO NOT soak or wipe the lens with any product not listed in the Voluson™S8 /
Voluson™S6 Basic User Manual and/or care card. Doing so could result in irreparable damage
to the probe and/or Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 system.
CAUTION Follow the Care Card instructions supplied with each probe (inside the transducer boxes)
!! CAUTION:
for disinfectants and gels that are compatible with the surface material of the probes.
CAUTION To help protect yourself from blood borne diseases, when cleaning and handling probes,
!! CAUTION:
wear approved, non-allergenic disposable gloves.
NOTICE Disinfect a defective probe before you return it. Be sure to tag the probe as being disinfected.
!! NOTICE:
CAUTION
CAUTION:
The RIC-Holder (especially developed for RIC Real-time 4D endocavity probes) guarantees that the
sensitive probe head does not hit the bottom of the container during the disinfection procedure.
To guarantee that the sensitive probe head does not hit the bottom of Endocavity Soaking Cup Kit
RIC-Holder Endocavity soaking cup kit is available at GE Accessory
the container, place the probe in the RIC Holder during the disinfection
(Order Nr. : E8385TA )
procedure.
OK
RIC-Holder
Disinfection fluid
RIC-Holder
Container
Section 10-6
Using a Phantom (Optional)
The use of a Phantom is not required during Preventiv maintenance. Customer may use it as part of
their Quality Assurance Program tests.
Section 10-7
Electrical Safety Tests
10-7-1 Safety Test Overview
The electrical safety tests in this section are based on and conform to IEC60601-1 standard including
national deviations. They are intended for the electrical safety evaluation of cord-connected, electrically
operated, patient care equipment. If additional information is needed, refer to IEC 60601-1 documents
including national deviations.
WARNING
WARNING THE USER MUST ENSURE THAT THE SAFETY INSPECTIONS ARE PERFORMED AT
!! WARNING:
LEAST EVERY 12 MONTHS ACCORDING TO THE REQUIREMENTS OF THE PATIENT
SAFETY STANDARD IEC60601-1 standard including national deviations. ONLY
TRAINED PERSONS ARE ALLOWED TO PERFORM THE SAFETY INSPECTIONS
MENTIONED ABOVE.
CAUTION To avoid electrical shock, the unit under test must not be connected to other electrical
!! CAUTION:
equipment. Remove all interconnecting cables and wires. The unit under test must not be
contacted by users or patients while performing these tests.
CAUTION Possible risk of infection. Do not handle soiled or contaminated probes and other components
!! CAUTION:
that have been in patient contact. Follow appropriate cleaning and disinfecting procedures
before handling the equipment.
WARNING
WARNING Test the Voluson™S8 / Voluson™S6 system, peripherals and probes for leakage
!! WARNING:
current.
Excessive leakage current can cause FATAL INJURY OR DEATH.
High leakage current can also indicate degradation of insulation and a potential for
electrical failure. DO NOT use probes or equipment having excessive leakage current.
CAUTION Compare all safety-test results with safety-test results of previously performed safety tests e.g.
!! CAUTION:
last year etc. In case of unexplainable abrupt changes of safety-test results consult experienced
authorized service personnel or GE for further analysis.
To minimize the risk of a probe causing electrical shock, the customer should observe the following
recommendations:
Table 10-11 Enclosure Leakage Current Limits -Accessible Surfaces not protectively earthed
Country
Conditions
USA Others
Close Protective earth and close neutral with normal polarity 0.1 mA* 0.1 mA***
Close Protective earth and close neutral with reverse polarity 0.1 mA* 0.1 mA***
Open Protective earth and close neutral with normal polarity 0.3 mA** 0.5 mA***
Open Protective earth and close neutral with reverse polarity 0.3 mA** 0.5 mA***
Open neutral and close Protective earth with normal polarity 0.5 mA* 0.5 mA***
Open neutral and close Protective earth with reverse polarity 0.5 mA* 0.5 mA***
Country
Conditions
USA Others
Close Protective earth and close neutral with normal polarity 0.3 mA** 0.5 mA***
Close Protective earth and close neutral with reverse polarity 0.3 mA** 0.5 mA***
Open neutral and close Protective earth with normal polarity 1 mA* 1 mA***
Open neutral and close Protective earth with reverse polarity 1 mA* 1 mA***
Country
Conditions
USA Others
Close Protective earth and close neutral with normal polarity 0.1 mA* 0.1 mA***
Close Protective earth and close neutral with reverse polarity 0.1 mA* 0.1 mA***
Open Protective earth and close neutral with normal polarity 0.5 mA* 0.5 mA***
Open Protective earth and close neutral with reverse polarity 0.5 mA* 0.5 mA***
Open neutral and close Protective earth with normal polarity 0.5 mA* 0.5 mA***
Open neutral and close Protective earth with reverse polarity 0.5 mA* 0.5 mA***
Country
Conditions
USA Others
Close Protective earth and close neutral with normal polarity 0.01 mA* 0.01 mA***
Close Protective earth and close neutral with reverse polarity 0.01 mA* 0.01 mA***
Open Protective earth and close neutral with normal polarity 0.05 mA* 0.05 mA***
Open Protective earth and close neutral with reverse polarity 0.05 mA* 0.05 mA***
Open neutral and close Protective earth with normal polarity 0.05 mA* 0.05 mA***
Open neutral and close Protective earth with reverse polarity 0.05 mA* 0.05 mA***
Country
Conditions
USA Others
Close Protective earth and close neutral with normal polarity 0.01 mA* 0.01 mA***
Close Protective earth and close neutral with reverse polarity 0.01 mA* 0.01 mA***
Open Protective earth and close neutral with normal polarity 0.05 mA* 0.05 mA***
Open Protective earth and close neutral with reverse polarity 0.05 mA* 0.05 mA***
Open neutral and close Protective earth with normal polarity 0.05 mA* 0.05 mA***
Open neutral and close Protective earth with reverse polarity 0.05 mA* 0.05 mA***
Table 10-16 Isolation between Mains and Applied Limits****- Patient Leakage Main to Type BF
Applied part
Country
Conditions
USA Others
Close Protective earth and close neutral with normal polarity 5 mA* 5 mA***
Close Protective earth and close neutral with reverse polarity 5 mA* 5 mA***
Table 10-17 Isolation between Mains and Applied Limits****- Patient Leakage Main to Type CF
Applied part
Country
Conditions
USA Others
Close Protective earth and close neutral with normal polarity 0.05 mA* 0.05 mA***
Close Protective earth and close neutral with reverse polarity 0.05 mA* 0.05 mA***
Table 10-18 Total Patient leakage current: Type CF probe to ground (Only for Europe)
Conditions Limitation
Close Protective earth and close neutral with normal polarity 0.05 mA*****
Close Protective earth and close neutral with reverse polarity 0.05 mA*****
Open Protective earth and close neutral with normal polarity 0.1mA*****
Open Protective earth and close neutral with reverse polarity 0.1mA*****
Open neutral and close Protective earth with normal polarity 0.1mA*****
Open neutral and close Protective earth with reverse polarity 0.1mA*****
Table 10-19 Total Patient leakage current: Type CF probe to Mains (Only for Europe)
Conditions Limitation
Close Protective earth and close neutral with normal polarity 0.1 mA******
Close Protective earth and close neutral with reverse polarity 0.1 mA******
NOTE: * Measurement limits per UL 60601-1 Medical Electrical Equipment Safety Standards Table IV
** Measurement limits per UL 60601-1 Medical Electrical Equipment Safety Standards, Table
19.5DV.1 *** Measurement limits per IEC 60601-1 Ed 2. Medical Electrical Equipment Safety
Standards, Table IV
**** Isolation between Mains and Applied Limits refers to the measurement of leakage current
flow which would flow from mains to patient if the patient were to come into contact with mains
voltage.
*****Measurement limits per IEC 60601-1 Ed 3. Medical Electrical Equipment Safety Standards, Table 3
******Measurement limits per IEC 60601-1 Ed 3. Medical Electrical Equipment Safety Standards, Table
4
The following tests are performed at the factory and should be performed at the customer site as well.
- Grounding Continuity
- Earth Leakage Current
- Enclosure Leakage Current
- Patient Leakage Current
All measurements should be made with an electrical safety analyzer.
NOTE: No outlet tester can detect the condition where the Neutral (grounded supply) conductor and the
Grounding (protective earth) conductor are reversed. If later tests indicate high leakage currents, this
should be suspected as a possible cause and the outlet wiring should be visually inspected.
Measure the resistance from the third pin of the attachment plug to the exposed protectively-earthed
metal parts of the case. The ground wire resistance should be less than 0.2 ohms.
Reference the procedure in the IEC60601-1-1.
GROUND PIN
OHMMETER
10-7-5-1 Definition
This test measures the current that would flow in a grounded person who touched accessible non-
protectively-earthed parts of equipment if the ground wire were to break. The test verifies the isolation
of the power line from the chassis.
The meter is connected from accessible non-protectively-earthed parts of the case to ground.
Measurements should be made with the ground open and closed, with power line polarity normal and
reversed, and with the neutral open and closed. Record the highest reading.
When the meter's ground switch is OPEN, DO NOT not touch the unit!
CAUTION Equipment damage possibility. Never switch the Polarity and the status of Neutral when the unit
!! CAUTION:
is powered ON. Be sure to turn the unit power OFF before switching them using the POLARITY
switch and/or the NEUTRAL switch. Otherwise, the unit may be damaged.
Figure 10-3 Set Up for Test of Enclosure Leakage Current, IEC 60601-1 Clause 19
Hot : Black
Neutral : White
ii)Others
Hot : Brown
Neutral : Blue
Ground : Green-yellow
Electrical leakage testing may be accomplished with any calibrated Electrical Safety Analyzer tool
compliant with AAMI/ESI 1993 or IEC 60601 or AS/NZS 3551.
When using a test instrument, its power plug may be inserted into the wall outlet and the equipment
under test is plugged into the receptacle on the panel of the meter. This places the meter in the
grounding conductor and the current flowing from the case to ground will be indicated in any of the
current ranges. The maximum allowable limit for chassis source leakage is shown in Table 10-11 on
page 10-13.
10-7-6-1 Definition
This test measures the current that would flow to a grounded person who touched accessible
protectively-earthed parts of equipment if the ground wire should break.
The meter is connected from accessible protectively-earthed parts of the equipment to ground.
Measurements should be made with power line polarity normal and reversed, and with the neutral open
and closed Record the highest reading.
CAUTION Equipment damage possibility, Never switch the Polarity and the status of Neutral when the unit
!! CAUTION:
is powered ON. Be sure to turn the unit power OFF before switching them using the POLARITY
switch and/or the NEUTRAL switch. Otherwise, the unit may be damaged.
Figure 10-4 Set Up for Test of Earth Leakage Current, IEC 60601-1 Clause 19
Hot : Black
Neutral : White
ii) Others
Hot : Brown
Neutral : Blue
Ground : Green-yellow
Electrical leakage testing may be accomplished with any calibrated Electrical Safety Analyzer tool
compliant with AAMI/ESI 1993 or IEC 60601 or AS/NZS 3551.
When using a test instrument, its power plug may be inserted into the wall outlet and the equipment
under test is plugged into the receptacle on the panel of the meter. This places the meter in the
grounding conductor and the current flowing through protective earth will be indicated in any of the
current ranges. The maximum allowable limit for earth leakage current is shown in Table 10-12 on
page 10-13.
10-7-7-1 Definition
This test measures the current which would flow to ground from any of the isolated ECG leads. The
meter simulates a patient who is connected to the ECG equipment and is grounded by touching some
other grounded surface. Measurements should be made with the ground open and closed, with power
line polarity normal and reversed, and with the neutral open and closed. For each combination, the
operating controls, such as the lead switch, should be operated to find the worst case condition.
CAUTION Equipment damage possibility. Never switch the Polarity and the status of Neutral when the unit
!! CAUTION:
is powered ON. Be sure to turn the unit power OFF before switching them using the POLARITY
switch and/or the NEUTRAL switch. Otherwise, the unit may be damaged.
Figure 10-5 Test Circuit for Measuring Leakage current between patient lead and Ground - Isolated
Neutral : White
Ground : Green or Green-yellow
ii) Others
Hot : Brown
Neutral : Blue
Ground : Green-yellow
Table 10-22 Typical Data Sheet for Type CF Patient Leakage Current Test - ECG
Leads
10-7-8-1 Definition
This test measures the current that would flow to ground from any of the probes through a patient who
is being scanned and becomes grounded by touching some other grounded surface.
NOTE: Some leakage current is expected on each probe, depending on its design. Small variations in probe
leakage currents are normal from probe to probe. Other variations will result from differences in line
voltage and test lead placement.
It is abnormal if no leakage current is measured. If no leakage current is detected, check the
configuration of the test equipment.
CAUTION Equipment damage possibility. Never switch the Polarity and the status of Neutral when the unit
!! CAUTION:
is powered ON. Be sure to turn the unit power OFF before switching them using the POLARITY
switch and/or the NEUTRAL switch. Otherwise, the unit may be damaged.
NOTE: Saline water pod should be insulated from floor and earth ground.
Table 10-23 Typical Data Sheet for Type BF Patient Leakage Current Test
Tester Neutral Tester Polarity Switch Ground Switch Measured Leakage Current
Closed Normal Closed
Closed Normal Open
Closed Reversed Closed
Closed Reversed Open
Open Normal Closed
Open Reversed Closed
CAUTION Equipment damage possibility. Never switch the Polarity and the status of Neutral when the unit
!! CAUTION:
is powered ON. Be sure to turn the unit power OFF before switching them using the POLARITY
switch and/or the NEUTRAL switch. Otherwise, the unit may be damaged.
Table 10-24 Typical Data Sheet for Type BF Patient Auxiliary Current Test
Measured Leakage
Tester Neutral Tester Polarity Switch Ground Switch
Current
Closed Normal Closed
Closed Normal Open
Closed Reversed Closed
Closed Reversed Open
Open Normal Closed
Open Reversed Closed
Line voltage is applied to Probe during this test. To avoid possible electric shock hazard, the
system being tested must not be touched by patients, users or anyone during testing.
CAUTION Equipment damage possibility. Never switch the Polarity and the status of Neutral when the unit
!! CAUTION:
is powered ON. Be sure to turn the unit power OFF before switching them using the POLARITY
switch and/or the NEUTRAL switch. Otherwise, the unit may be damaged.
Table 10-25 Typical Data Sheet for Type BF Patient Leakage Current - Mains to Probe
Measured Leakage
Tester Neutral Tester Polarity Switch Ground Switch Current
Line voltage is applied to the ECG leads during this test. To avoid possible electric shock
hazard, the system being tested must not be touched by patients, users or anyone during
testing.
CAUTION Equipment damage possibility. Never switch the Polarity and the status of Neutral when the unit
!! CAUTION:
is powered ON. Be sure to turn the unit power OFF before switching them using the POLARITY
switch and/or the NEUTRAL switch. Otherwise, the unit may be damaged.
Table 10-26 Typical Data Sheet for Type CF Patient Leakage Current - Mains to ECG Lead
Measured Leakage
Tester Neutral Tester Polarity Switch Ground Switch Current
Measured Leakage
Tester Neutral Tester Polarity Switch Ground Switch Current
10-7-12 Total Patient leakage current : Type CF probe to ground(Only for Europe)
10-7-12-1 Definition
This test measures the current that would flow to ground from all ECG leads through a patient who is
being scanned and becomes grounded by touching some other grounded surface.
CAUTION Equipment damage possibility. Never switch the Polarity and the status of Neutral when the unit
!! CAUTION:
is powered ON. Be sure to turn the unit power OFF before switching them using the POLARITY
switch and/or the NEUTRAL switch. Otherwise, the unit may be damaged.
Table 10-27 Typical Data Sheet for Total Patient Leakage Current - Type CF probes to ground
Tester Neutral Tester Polarity Switch Ground Switch Measured Leakage Current
10-7-13 Total Patient leakage current : Mains to Type CF probe (Only for Europe)
Reference the procedure in the IEC 60601-1 Ed 3. Measure leakage current flow from mains to all ECG
leads connected together.
Line voltage is applied to the ECG leads during this test. To avoid possible electric shock
hazard, the system being tested must not be touched by patients, users or anyone during
testing.
CAUTION Equipment damage possibility. Never switch the Polarity and the status of Neutral when the unit
!! CAUTION:
is powered ON. Be sure to turn the unit power OFF before switching them using the POLARITY
switch and/or the NEUTRAL switch. Otherwise, the unit may be damaged.
Table 10-28 Typical Data Sheet for Total Patient Leakage Current - Mains to Type CF probes
Tester Neutral Tester Polarity Switch Ground Switch Measured Leakage Current
Section 10-8
When There's Too Much Leakage Current...
10-8-1 Earth and/or Enclosure Fails
Follow the below checklist in case of earth and/or enclosure leakage current failure.
• Confirm the ground of the power cord and plug for continuity.
• Ensure the ground is not broken, frayed or intermittent. If that, replace any defective part.
• Tighten all grounds. Ensure star washers are under all ground studs.
• Inspect wiring for bad crimps, poor connections, or damage.
• Test the wall outlet. Verify it is grounded and is free of other wiring abnormalities. If any deviation
is found, notify the user or owner to correct it. In this case, check the other outlets to see if they
could be used instead as a workaround.
NOTE: No outlet tester can detect the condition where the white neutral wire and the green grounding wire are
reversed. If later tests indicate high leakage currents, this should be suspected as a possible cause and
the outlet wiring should be visually inspected.
NOTE: Each probe will have some amount of leakage, dependent on its design. Small variations in probe
leakage currents are normal from probe to probe. Other variations will result from differences in line
voltage and test lead placement. The maximum allowable leakage current for body surface contact
probe differs from an inter-cavity probe. Be sure to enter the correct probe type in the appropriate
space on the check list.
• Test the probe in another connector to isolate if the fault lies with the probe or the scanner.
If excessive leakage current is slot dependent, inspect the system connector for bent pins, poor
connections, and ground continuity.
ELECTRICAL SAFETY
Outlet and Ground Continuity test
Tester
Value
Tester Neutral Polarity Max Value Allowed OK? Comments
Measured
Switch
Tester Protective
Tester Test 1 Test 2 Optional Optional
Polarity Earth Max Value Allowed OK? Comments
Neutral Wheel LCD Test 3 Test 4
Switch Switch
0.1mA(USA)/
Closed Normal Closed
0.1mA(Others)
0.3mA(USA)/
Closed Normal Open
0.5mA(Others)
0.1mA(USA)/
Closed Reversed Closed
0.1mA(Others)
0.3mA(USA)/
Closed Reversed Open
0.5mA(Others)
0.5mA(USA)/
Open Normal Closed
0.5mA(Others)
0.5mA(USA)/
Open Reversed Closed
0.5mA(Others)
ECG lead 1
ECG lead 2
ECG lead 3
Type BF Patient Leakage Current Test - Probes (This test should be done for all probe)
Final Check. All system covers are in place. System scans with all probes as expected.
www.gehealthcare.com